]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
gdb/tui: add a missing white space character
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
a2c58332 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
a2c58332 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
a2c58332 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 686field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
6f365fda
L
1296@item indirect-extern-access
1297@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306section.
1307
cd6d6c15
NC
1308@item initfirst
1309This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314objects.
1315
1316@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1320
c3805e4c
VDM
1321@item unique
1322@itemx nounique
1323When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
279d901e
L
1331@item lam-u48
1332Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335@item lam-u57
1336Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u48-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-u57-report=none
1352@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363@item lam-report=none
1364@itemx lam-report=warning
1365@itemx lam-report=error
1366Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
5fa222e4
AM
1375@item lazy
1376When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379Lazy binding is the default.
1380
cd6d6c15 1381@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1382Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1383
e6e2dfbd
AM
1384@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1386
e6e2dfbd
AM
1387@item muldefs
1388Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1389
cd6d6c15 1390@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1391Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1393
1394@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1395Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1397
1398@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1399Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1400
1401@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1402Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1403
1404@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1405Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1406
6aa29e7b
JJ
1407@item noexecstack
1408Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item noextern-protected-data
1411Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1417
e6e2dfbd
AM
1418@item noreloc-overflow
1419Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1422
cd6d6c15
NC
1423@item now
1424When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1426when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1429
1430@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1431Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1432
6a91be86
L
1433@item pack-relative-relocs
1434@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1435Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1436and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1437@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1438building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1439@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1440relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1441GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1442added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1443
6aa29e7b 1444@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1445@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1446Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1447specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1448relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1449than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1450Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1451
68b00778
L
1452@item report-relative-reloc
1453Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1454Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1455
47acac12
L
1456@item separate-code
1457@itemx noseparate-code
1458Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1459specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1460be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1461code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1462
e6e2dfbd
AM
1463@item shstk
1464Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1465to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1466Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1467
04c3a755 1468@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1469Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1470Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1471@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1472
8ee10e86
AM
1473@item start-stop-gc
1474@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1475@cindex start-stop-gc
1476When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1477section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1478input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1479@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1480@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1481linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1482sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1483were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1484definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1485object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1486linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1487@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1488treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1489
cae64165
RM
1490@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1491@cindex visibility
1492@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1493Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1494@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1495Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1496@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1497start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1498compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1499recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1500programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1501between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1502
e6e2dfbd
AM
1503@item text
1504@itemx notext
1505@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1506Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1507or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1508report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1509
97a232d7
NC
1510@item undefs
1511Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1512either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1513This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1514
2d95647b
L
1515@item unique-symbol
1516@itemx nounique-symbol
1517Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1518".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1519is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1520
b0ab0693 1521@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1522@item x86-64-v2
1523@item x86-64-v3
1524@itemx x86-64-v4
1525Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1526@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1527@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1528@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1529@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1530Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1531
cd6d6c15
NC
1532@end table
1533
ece2d90e 1534Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1535
1536@kindex -(
1537@cindex groups of archives
1538@item -( @var{archives} -)
1539@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1540The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1541either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1542
1543The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1544references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1545the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1546archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1547object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1548would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1549they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1550resolved.
1551
1552Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1553it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1554more archives.
1555
69da35b5
NC
1556@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1557@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1558@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1559@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1560Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1561recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1562and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1563the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1564behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1565so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1566restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1567
4a43e768
AM
1568@kindex --as-needed
1569@kindex --no-as-needed
1570@item --as-needed
1571@itemx --no-as-needed
1572This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1573on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1574the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1575on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1576needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1577emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1578non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1579the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1580non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1581Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1582the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1583needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1584from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1585
6418520e
NC
1586Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1587an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1588@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1589@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1590
e56f61be
L
1591@kindex --add-needed
1592@kindex --no-add-needed
1593@item --add-needed
1594@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1595These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1596their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1597options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1598and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1599
252b5132
RH
1600@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1601@item -assert @var{keyword}
1602This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1603
1604@kindex -Bdynamic
1605@kindex -dy
1606@kindex -call_shared
1607@item -Bdynamic
1608@itemx -dy
1609@itemx -call_shared
1610Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1611for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1612default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1613for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1614multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1615@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1616
a1ab1d2a
UD
1617@kindex -Bgroup
1618@item -Bgroup
1619Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1620section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1621object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1622@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1623only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1624
252b5132
RH
1625@kindex -Bstatic
1626@kindex -dn
1627@kindex -non_shared
1628@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1629@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1630@itemx -dn
1631@itemx -non_shared
1632@itemx -static
1633Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1634platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1635variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1636may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1637library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1638option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1639option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1640shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1641references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1642libraries.
252b5132
RH
1643
1644@kindex -Bsymbolic
1645@item -Bsymbolic
1646When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1647definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1648for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1649within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1650platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1651
40b36307
L
1652@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1653@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1654When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1655symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1656This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1657libraries.
40b36307 1658
cf893b0e
FS
1659@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1660@item -Bno-symbolic
1661This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1662@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1663
55255dae
L
1664@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1665@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1666Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1667typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1668global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1669within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1670to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1671in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1672which support shared libraries.
1673
1674The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1675scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1676
40b36307
L
1677@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1678@item --dynamic-list-data
1679Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1680
1681@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1682@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1683Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1684is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1685
0b8a70d9
L
1686@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1687@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1688Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1689
252b5132
RH
1690@kindex --check-sections
1691@kindex --no-check-sections
1692@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1693@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1694Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1695been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1696perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1697suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1698allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1699restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1700Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1701force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1702option.
252b5132 1703
ddbb8a31
NC
1704@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1705@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1706@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1707@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1708This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1709by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1710command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1711output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1712input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1713specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1714follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1715behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1716
1717This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1718libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1719mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1720their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1721required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1722the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1723dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1724symbols.
1725
252b5132
RH
1726@cindex cross reference table
1727@kindex --cref
1728@item --cref
1729Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1730generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1731Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1732
1733The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1734easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1735sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1736symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1737definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1738where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1739symbol are listed.
252b5132 1740
5dba6f05
NA
1741@cindex ctf variables
1742@kindex --ctf-variables
1743@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1744@item --ctf-variables
1745@item --no-ctf-variables
1746The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1747types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1748table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1749conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1750usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1751@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1752The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1753
1754@cindex ctf type sharing
1755@kindex --ctf-share-types
1756@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1757Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1758
1759@table @samp
1760@item share-unconflicted
1761Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1762where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1763translation unit. This is the default.
1764
1765@item share-duplicated
1766Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1767dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1768dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1769always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1770larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1771large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1772consumer at runtime.
1773@end table
1774
4818e05f
AM
1775@cindex common allocation
1776@kindex --no-define-common
1777@item --no-define-common
1778This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1779The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1780@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
1782The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1783the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1784of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1785forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1786Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1787from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1788This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1789and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1790duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1791paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1792
7bdf4127
AB
1793@cindex group allocation in linker script
1794@cindex section groups
1795@cindex COMDAT
1796@kindex --force-group-allocation
1797@item --force-group-allocation
1798This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1799normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1800default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1801change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1802command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1803effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1804
252b5132 1805@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1806@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1807@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1808Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1809address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1810times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1811limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1812context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1813symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1814constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1815using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1816@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1817equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1818
54874444
AB
1819The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1820in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1821symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1822placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1823the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1824consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1825@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1826you are trying to achieve.
1827
252b5132 1828@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1829@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1830@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1831@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1832@itemx --no-demangle
1833These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1834and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1835present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1836underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1837mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1838different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1839to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1840demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1841is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1842
1843@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1844@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1845@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1846@item -I@var{file}
1847@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1848Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1849generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1850linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1851doing.
1852
9b8b325a
RF
1853@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1854@item --no-dynamic-linker
1855When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1856linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1857executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1858entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1859
a70f34c0
NC
1860@kindex --embedded-relocs
1861@item --embedded-relocs
1862This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1863that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1864is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1865targets.
1866
3f0a5f17
ME
1867@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1868@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1869Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1870in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1871
7ce691ae 1872@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1873@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1874@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1875@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1876Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1877with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1878
252b5132
RH
1879@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1880@item --force-exe-suffix
1881Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1882
1883If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1884@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1885the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1886option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1887Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1888it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1889
1890@kindex --gc-sections
1891@kindex --no-gc-sections
1892@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1893@item --gc-sections
1894@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1895Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1896targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1897performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1898@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1899collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1900implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1901
d5465ba2
AM
1902@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1903examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1904symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1905command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1906referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1907libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1908referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1909the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1910relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1911@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1912
ac69cbc6 1913This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1914@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1915specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1916@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1917command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1918
99fabbc9
JL
1919As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1920@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1921
c17d87de
NC
1922@kindex --print-gc-sections
1923@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1924@cindex garbage collection
1925@item --print-gc-sections
1926@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1927List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1928printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1929collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1930default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1931be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1932line.
1933
22185505 1934@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1935@cindex garbage collection
1936@item --gc-keep-exported
1937When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1938collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1939default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1940executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1941collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1942Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1943it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1944ELF format targets.
1945
30824704
RM
1946@kindex --print-output-format
1947@cindex output format
1948@item --print-output-format
1949Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1950other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1951in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1952
3604cb1f
TG
1953@kindex --print-memory-usage
1954@cindex memory usage
1955@item --print-memory-usage
1956Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1957the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1958quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1959headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1960parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1961
1962@smallexample
1963Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1964 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1965 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1966@end smallexample
1967
252b5132
RH
1968@cindex help
1969@cindex usage
1970@kindex --help
1971@item --help
1972Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1973
ea20a7da
CC
1974@kindex --target-help
1975@item --target-help
a094d01f 1976Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1977
2509a395
SL
1978@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1979@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1980Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1981@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1982@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1983
1984Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1985written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1986inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1987file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1988@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1989output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1990@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1991
1992@smallexample
1993 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1994 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1995 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1996 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1997 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1998 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2001 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2003@end smallexample
2004
2005It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2006
2007If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2008operation.
252b5132
RH
2009
2010@cindex memory usage
2011@kindex --no-keep-memory
2012@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2013@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2014symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2015instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2016necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2017while linking a large executable.
2018
2019@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2020@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2021@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2022@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2023@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2024Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2025is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2026The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2027behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2028libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2029
97a232d7
NC
2030The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2031
aa713662
L
2032@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2033@kindex -z muldefs
2034@item --allow-multiple-definition
2035@itemx -z muldefs
2036Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2037report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2038first definition will be used.
2039
b79e8c78 2040@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2041@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2042@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2043@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2044Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2045This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2046determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2047shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2048how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2049
903249d7
NC
2050The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2051referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2052an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2053a shared library.
2054
2055The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2056libraries specified at link time are that:
2057
2058@itemize @bullet
2059@item
2060A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2061that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2062resolvable at load time.
2063@item
2064There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2065symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2066
2067The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2068select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2069architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2070appropriate memset function.
2071@end itemize
b79e8c78 2072
23ae20f5
NC
2073@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2074@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2075If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2076@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2077only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2078libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2079``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2080undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2081will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2082might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2083error message will be displayed.
2084
2085The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2086switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2087
31941635
L
2088@kindex --no-undefined-version
2089@item --no-undefined-version
2090Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2091it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2092will be issued instead.
2093
3e3b46e5
PB
2094@kindex --default-symver
2095@item --default-symver
2096Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2097exported symbols.
2098
2099@kindex --default-imported-symver
2100@item --default-imported-symver
2101Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2102imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2103
252b5132
RH
2104@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2105@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2106Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2107files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2108been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2109This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2110errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2111have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2112inappropriate.
2113
fe7929ce
AM
2114@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2115@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2116Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2117library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2118
252b5132
RH
2119@kindex --no-whole-archive
2120@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2121Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2122archive files.
2123
2124@cindex output file after errors
2125@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2126@item --noinhibit-exec
2127Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2128Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2129errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2130when it issues any error whatsoever.
2131
0a9c1c8e
CD
2132@kindex -nostdlib
2133@item -nostdlib
2134Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2135command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2136(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2137
252b5132 2138@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2139@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2140@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2141@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2142file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2143@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2144object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2145object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2146should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2147usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2148name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2149list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2150command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2151this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2152@end ifclear
2153
76359541
TP
2154@kindex --out-implib
2155@item --out-implib @var{file}
2156Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2157the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2158library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2159may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2160behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2161step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2162the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2163
36af4a4e
JJ
2164@kindex -pie
2165@kindex --pic-executable
2166@item -pie
2167@itemx --pic-executable
2168@cindex position independent executables
2169Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2170ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2171libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2172address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2173normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2174defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2175
e8f6c2a5
FS
2176@kindex -no-pie
2177@item -no-pie
2178@cindex position dependent executables
2179Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2180
252b5132
RH
2181@kindex -qmagic
2182@item -qmagic
2183This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2184
2185@kindex -Qy
2186@item -Qy
2187This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2188
2189@kindex --relax
2190@cindex synthesizing linker
2191@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2192@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2193@item --relax
28d5f677 2194@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2195An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2196@ifset GENERIC
2197This option is only supported on a few targets.
2198@end ifset
2199@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2200@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2201@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2202@ifset XTENSA
2203@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2204@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2205@ifset M68HC11
2206@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2207@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2208@ifset NIOSII
2209@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2210@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2211@ifset POWERPC
2212@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2213@end ifset
252b5132 2214
ccd9fae5 2215On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2216global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2217addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2218synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2219instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2220
2221On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2222debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2223@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2224This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2225family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2226@end ifset
2227
ccd9fae5
NC
2228On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2229@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2230
ccd9fae5
NC
2231On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2232and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2233
252b5132
RH
2234@cindex retaining specified symbols
2235@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2236@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2237@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2238@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2239Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2240discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2241symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2242@ifset GENERIC
2243(such as VxWorks)
2244@end ifset
2245where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2246run-time memory.
2247
2248@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2249or symbols needed for relocations.
2250
2251You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2252line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2253
2254@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2255@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2256@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2257@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2258Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2259linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2260arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2261them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2262
2263The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2264are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2265description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2266in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2267have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2268
2269If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2270contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2271is defined.
252b5132 2272
ff5dcc92 2273The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2274SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2275@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2276runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2277options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2278gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2279file systems.
252b5132 2280
ff5dcc92 2281For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2282followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2283the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2284@end ifset
2285
2286@ifset GENERIC
2287@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2288@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2289@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2290When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2291happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2292of the input files.
2293
2294When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2295non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2296shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2297explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2298specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2299@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2300either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2301appearing multiple times.
2302
e680a6b6
NC
2303The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2304directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2305containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2306and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
230764-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2308
2309The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2310@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2311supported.
2312
28c309a2
NC
2313This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2314that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2315is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2316runtime linker would do.
2317
252b5132 2318The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2319libraries:
d8e4137b 2320
252b5132
RH
2321@enumerate
2322@item
ff5dcc92 2323Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2324@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2325Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2326between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2327specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2328used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2329at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2330by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2331the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2332@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2333On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2334@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2335environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2336@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2337On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2338directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2339@item
a1b8d843 2340For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2341variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2342@item
ec4eb78a
L
2343For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2344@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2345libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2346@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2347@item
d8e4137b
NC
2348For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2349exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2350to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2351defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2352configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2353@item
2354For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2355the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2356header file.
2357@item
364d7729
AM
2358Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2359linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2360by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2361@item
2362The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2363@item
2364Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2365@item
2366Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2367linker script.
252b5132
RH
2368@end enumerate
2369
6418520e
NC
2370Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2371the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2372is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2373library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2374@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2375directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2376this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2377@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2378of the first.
2379
252b5132
RH
2380If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2381warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2382
252b5132
RH
2383@end ifset
2384
2385@kindex -shared
2386@kindex -Bshareable
2387@item -shared
2388@itemx -Bshareable
2389@cindex shared libraries
2390Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2391and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2392shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2393undefined symbols in the link.
2394
252b5132 2395@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2396@item --sort-common
2397@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2398@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2399This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2400ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2401sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2402eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2403between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2404specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2405
2509a395
SL
2406@kindex --sort-section=name
2407@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2408This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2409patterns in the linker script.
2410
2509a395
SL
2411@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2412@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2413This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2414patterns in the linker script.
2415
a70f34c0
NC
2416@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2417@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2418This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2419.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2420post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2421
252b5132 2422@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2423@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2424Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2425each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2426size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2427
2428@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2429@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2430Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2431output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2432This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2433certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2434cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2435that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2436support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2437input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2438more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2439many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2440
2441@kindex --stats
2442@item --stats
2443Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2444as execution time and memory usage.
2445
2509a395 2446@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2447@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2448Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2449configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2450that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2451
a70f34c0
NC
2452@kindex --task-link
2453@item --task-link
2454This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2455file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2456
252b5132
RH
2457@kindex --traditional-format
2458@cindex traditional format
2459@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2460For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2461the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2462use the traditional format instead.
2463
2464@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2465For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2466symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2467full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2468@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2469trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2470combine duplicate entries.
2471
2509a395
SL
2472@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2473@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2474Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2475address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2476times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2477line.
2478@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2479for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2480@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2481should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2482sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2483
2509a395
SL
2484@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2485@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2486@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2487@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2488@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2489@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2490@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2491Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2492@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2493
2509a395
SL
2494@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2495@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2496@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2497When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2498byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2499
9d5777a3
RM
2500@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2501@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2502@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2503When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2504the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2505text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2506
0d705e9f
AM
2507@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2508@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2509@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2510When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2511model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2512
560e09e9
NC
2513@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2514@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2515Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2516values for @samp{method}:
2517
2518@table @samp
2519@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2520Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2521
2522@item report-all
da8bce14 2523Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2524
2525@item ignore-in-object-files
2526Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2527ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2528
2529@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2530Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2531ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2532when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2533libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2534command line.
2535@end table
2536
2537The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2538by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2539
2540Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2541unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2542can change this to a warning.
2543
1715a13c
L
2544@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2545@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2546@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2547@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2548Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2549supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2550the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2551argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2552
2553@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2554@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2555@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2556Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2557used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2558about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2559is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2560see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2561use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2562symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2563@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2564
7ce691ae 2565@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2566@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2567@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2568@item --warn-common
2569Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2570a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2571but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2572you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2573Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2574warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2575
2576There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2577
2578@table @samp
2579@item int i = 1;
2580A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2581file.
2582
2583@item extern int i;
2584An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2585There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2586variable somewhere.
2587
2588@item int i;
2589A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2590variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2591The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2592single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2593size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2594a definition of the same variable.
2595@end table
2596
2597The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2598Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2599just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2600encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2601a common symbol.
2602
2603@enumerate
2604@item
2605Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2606definition for the symbol.
2607@smallexample
2608@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2609 overridden by definition
2610@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2611@end smallexample
2612
2613@item
2614Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2615the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2616except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2617@smallexample
2618@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2619 overriding common
2620@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2621@end smallexample
2622
2623@item
2624Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2625@smallexample
2626@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2627 of `@var{symbol}'
2628@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2629@end smallexample
2630
2631@item
2632Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2633@smallexample
2634@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2635 overridden by larger common
2636@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2637@end smallexample
2638
2639@item
2640Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2641the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2642encountered in a different order.
2643@smallexample
2644@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2645 overriding smaller common
2646@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2647@end smallexample
2648@end enumerate
2649
2650@kindex --warn-constructors
2651@item --warn-constructors
2652Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2653object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2654detect the use of global constructors.
2655
2656@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2657@item --warn-multiple-gp
2658Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2659This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2660Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2661section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2662of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2663base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2664base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2665bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2666large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2667values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2668option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2669
2670@kindex --warn-once
2671@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2672@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2673@item --warn-once
2674Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2675which refers to it.
2676
2677@kindex --warn-section-align
2678@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2679@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2680@item --warn-section-align
2681Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2682alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2683The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2684is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2685the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2686
a6dbf402
L
2687@kindex --warn-textrel
2688@item --warn-textrel
2689Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2690or shared object.
8fdd7217 2691
a0c402a5
L
2692@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2693@item --warn-alternate-em
2694Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2695
560e09e9
NC
2696@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2697@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2698If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2699@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2700This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2701
2702@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2703@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2704This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2705it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2706
252b5132
RH
2707@kindex --whole-archive
2708@cindex including an entire archive
2709@item --whole-archive
2710For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2711@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2712in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2713files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2714library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2715library. This option may be used more than once.
2716
7ec229ce 2717Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2718about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2719Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2720list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2721your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2722
2509a395
SL
2723@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2724@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2725Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2726@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2727undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2728@var{symbol}.
2729
2730This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2731wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2732wishes to call the system function, it should call
2733@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2734
2735Here is a trivial example:
2736
2737@smallexample
2738void *
cc2f008e 2739__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2740@{
cc2f008e 2741 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2742 return __real_malloc (c);
2743@}
2744@end smallexample
2745
ff5dcc92 2746If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2747all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2748instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2749call the real @code{malloc} function.
2750
2751You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2752links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2753you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2754file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2755call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2756
4ea904ed
SH
2757Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2758internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2759@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2760@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2761
2762@smallexample
2763int
2764f (void)
2765@{
2766 return 123;
2767@}
2768
2769int
2770g (void)
2771@{
2772 return f();
2773@}
2774@end smallexample
2775
6aa29e7b 2776@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2777@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2778@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2779@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2780Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2781(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2782section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2783
e41b3a13
JJ
2784@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2785@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2786Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2787generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2788if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2789
6c1439be
L
2790@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2791@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2792@item --enable-new-dtags
2793@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2794This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2795systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2796@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2797and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2798If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2799created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2800those options are only available for ELF systems.
2801
2d643429 2802@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2803@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2804Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2805close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2806time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2807increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2808value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2809
fdc90cb4
JJ
2810@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2811@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2812Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2813@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2814new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2815the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2816hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2817but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2818
0ce398f1
L
2819@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2820@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2821@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2822@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2823@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2824@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2825@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2826@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2827On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2828compressed using zlib.
2829
2830@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2831sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2832DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2833instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2834also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2835sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2836
2837The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2838@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2839
2840Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2841sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2842for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2843uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2844
2845The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2846involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2847default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2848@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2849
35835446
JR
2850@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2851@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2852This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2853linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2854for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2855about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2856
4f9c04f7 2857Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28581021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2859run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2860has been used.
2861
2862The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2863enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2864
a8dde0a2
L
2865@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2866@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2867@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2868of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2869maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2870
c0065db7
RM
2871@kindex --build-id
2872@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2873@item --build-id
2874@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2875Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2876or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2877unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2878@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2879@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2880@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2881the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2882string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2883@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2884is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2885
2886The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2887that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2888unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2889to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2890file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2891string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2892
2893Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2894@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2895@end table
2896
0285c67d
NC
2897@c man end
2898
36f63dca 2899@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2900
0285c67d
NC
2901@c man begin OPTIONS
2902
ff5dcc92 2903The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2904the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2905normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2906use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2907@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2908like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2909symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2910object file).
2911
2912In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2913support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2914PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2915values by either a space or an equals sign.
2916
ff5dcc92 2917@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2918
2919@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2920@item --add-stdcall-alias
2921If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2922as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2923[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2924
2925@kindex --base-file
2926@item --base-file @var{file}
2927Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2928addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2929@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2930[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2931
2932@kindex --dll
2933@item --dll
2934Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2935@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2936file.
bb10df36 2937[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2938
88183869
DK
2939@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2940@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2941@item --enable-long-section-names
2942@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2943The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2944the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2945for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2946fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2947to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2948allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2949disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2950generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2951as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2952with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2953GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2954information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2955option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2956section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2957when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2958image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2959[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2960
252b5132
RH
2961@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2962@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2963@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2964@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2965If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2966do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2967only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2968resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2969undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2970@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2971to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2972warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2973import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2974to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2975feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2976@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2977mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2978[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2979
522f09cd
KT
2980@kindex --leading-underscore
2981@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2982@item --leading-underscore
2983@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2984For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2985in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2986disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2987
252b5132
RH
2988@cindex DLLs, creating
2989@kindex --export-all-symbols
2990@item --export-all-symbols
2991If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2992be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2993otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2994explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2995attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2996option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2997@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2998@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2999exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3000re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3001such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3002@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3003@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3004Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3005not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3006extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3007(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3008These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3009@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3010@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3011@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3012@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3013[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3014
3015@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3016@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3017Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3018exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3019[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3020
2927aaca
NC
3021@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3022@item --exclude-all-symbols
3023Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3024[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3025
252b5132
RH
3026@kindex --file-alignment
3027@item --file-alignment
3028Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3029file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3030512.
bb10df36 3031[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3032
3033@cindex heap size
3034@kindex --heap
3035@item --heap @var{reserve}
3036@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3037Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3038to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3039committed.
bb10df36 3040[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3041
3042@cindex image base
3043@kindex --image-base
3044@item --image-base @var{value}
3045Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3046the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3047is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3048your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3049other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3050for dlls.
bb10df36 3051[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3052
3053@kindex --kill-at
3054@item --kill-at
3055If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3056symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3057[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3058
26d2d8a2
BF
3059@kindex --large-address-aware
3060@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3061If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3062header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3063greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3064or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3065section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3066[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3067
f69a2f97
NC
3068@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3069@item --disable-large-address-aware
3070Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3071This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3072driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3073addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3074[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3075
252b5132
RH
3076@kindex --major-image-version
3077@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3078Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3079[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3080
3081@kindex --major-os-version
3082@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3083Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3084[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3085
3086@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3087@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3088Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3089[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3090
3091@kindex --minor-image-version
3092@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3093Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3094[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3095
3096@kindex --minor-os-version
3097@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3098Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3099[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3100
3101@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3102@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3103Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3105
3106@cindex DEF files, creating
3107@cindex DLLs, creating
3108@kindex --output-def
3109@item --output-def @var{file}
3110The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3111file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3112(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3113library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3114automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3115[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3116
b044cda1 3117@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3118@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3119@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3120@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3121Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3122@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3123By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3124for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3125execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3126[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3127
3128@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3129@item --disable-auto-image-base
3130Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3131user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3132default.
bb10df36 3133[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3134
3135@cindex DLLs, linking to
3136@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3137@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3138When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3139search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3140@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3141between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3142uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3143@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3144[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3145
3146@kindex --enable-auto-import
3147@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3148Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3149DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3150mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3151[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3152
3153The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3154feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3155
3156Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3157of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3158PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3159
e2a83dd0
NC
3160Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3161data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3162placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3163around a problem with consts that is described here:
3164http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3165
4d8907ac
DS
3166Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3167see this message:
0d888aac 3168
ece2d90e 3169"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3170documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3171
ece2d90e
NC
3172This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3173ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3174allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3175fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3176constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3177multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3178this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3179of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3180the warning, and exit.
3181
3182There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3183data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3184
2fa9fc65
NC
3185One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3186of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3187this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3188
c0065db7
RM
3189A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3190that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3191there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3192a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3193
3194@example
3195extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3196extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3197 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3198@end example
3199
3200or
3201
3202@example
3203extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3204extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3205 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3206@end example
3207
c0065db7 3208For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3209is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3210
3211@example
3212extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3213extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3214 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3215@end example
3216
c406afaf
NC
3217or
3218
3219@example
3220extern long long extern_ll;
3221extern_ll -->
3222 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3223@end example
3224
2fa9fc65 3225A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3226'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3227@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3228requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3229building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3230merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3231between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3232constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3233
3234Original:
3235@example
3236--foo.h
3237extern int arr[];
3238--foo.c
3239#include "foo.h"
3240void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3241 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3242@}
3243@end example
3244
3245Solution 1:
3246@example
3247--foo.h
3248extern int arr[];
3249--foo.c
3250#include "foo.h"
3251void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3252 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3253 volatile int *parr = arr;
3254 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3255@}
3256@end example
3257
3258Solution 2:
3259@example
3260--foo.h
3261/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3262#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3263 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3264#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3265#else
3266#define FOO_IMPORT
3267#endif
3268extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3269--foo.c
3270#include "foo.h"
3271void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3272 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3273@}
3274@end example
3275
c0065db7 3276A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3277library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3278for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3279functions).
b044cda1
CW
3280
3281@kindex --disable-auto-import
3282@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3283Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3284@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3285[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3286
2fa9fc65
NC
3287@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3288@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3289If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3290that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3291a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3292environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3293[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3294
3295@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3296@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3297Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3298[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3299
b044cda1
CW
3300@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3301@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3302Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3303[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3304
252b5132
RH
3305@kindex --section-alignment
3306@item --section-alignment
3307Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3308addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3309[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3310
3311@cindex stack size
3312@kindex --stack
3313@item --stack @var{reserve}
3314@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3315Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3316to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3317committed.
bb10df36 3318[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3319
3320@kindex --subsystem
3321@item --subsystem @var{which}
3322@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3323@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3324Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3325legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3326@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3327the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3328@var{which}.
bb10df36 3329[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3330
2f563b51
DK
3331The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3332of the PE file header:
3333[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3334
2d5c3743
NC
3335@kindex --high-entropy-va
3336@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3337@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3338Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3339(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3340
dc9bd8c9
HD
3341This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3342@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3343
2f563b51
DK
3344@kindex --dynamicbase
3345@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3346@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3347The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3348randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3349Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3350can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3351This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3352
3353@kindex --forceinteg
3354@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3355@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3356Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3357default.
2f563b51
DK
3358
3359@kindex --nxcompat
3360@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3361@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3362The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3363This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3364targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3365
3366@kindex --no-isolation
3367@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3368@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3369Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3370This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3371
3372@kindex --no-seh
3373@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3374@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3375The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3376this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3377
3378@kindex --no-bind
3379@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3380@itemx --disable-no-bind
3381Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3382
3383@kindex --wdmdriver
3384@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3385@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3386The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3387by default.
9d5777a3 3388
2f563b51
DK
3389@kindex --tsaware
3390@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3391@itemx --disable-tsaware
3392The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3393default.
2f563b51 3394
0cb112f7
CF
3395@kindex --insert-timestamp
3396@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3397@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3398Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3399as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3400other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3401will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3402same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3403can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3404that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3405identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3406
3407@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3408@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3409@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3410Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3411is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3412This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3413@end table
3414
0285c67d
NC
3415@c man end
3416
ac145307
BS
3417@ifset C6X
3418@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3419
3420@c man begin OPTIONS
3421
3422The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3423libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3424all executables use an index of 0.
3425
3426@table @gcctabopt
3427
3428@kindex --dsbt-size
3429@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3430This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3431or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3432entries.
3433
3434@kindex --dsbt-index
3435@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3436This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3437to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3438executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3439@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3440
fbd9ad90
PB
3441@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3442The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3443exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3444
ac145307
BS
3445@end table
3446
3447@c man end
3448@end ifset
3449
b8891f8d
AJ
3450@ifset CSKY
3451@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3452
3453@c man begin OPTIONS
3454
3455@table @gcctabopt
3456
3457@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3458@item --branch-stub
3459This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3460sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3461usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3462can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3463the compiler or assembler.
3464
3465@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3466@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3467This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3468It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3469be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3470stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3471sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3472@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3473linker should choose suitable defaults.
3474
3475@end table
3476
3477@c man end
3478@end ifset
3479
93fd0973
SC
3480@ifset M68HC11
3481@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3482
3483@c man begin OPTIONS
3484
3485The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3486memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3487
3488@table @gcctabopt
3489
3490@kindex --no-trampoline
3491@item --no-trampoline
3492This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3493is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3494instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3495
3496@kindex --bank-window
3497@item --bank-window @var{name}
3498This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3499the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3500The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3501paging and addresses within the memory window.
3502
3503@end table
3504
3505@c man end
3506@end ifset
3507
7fb9f789
NC
3508@ifset M68K
3509@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3510
3511@c man begin OPTIONS
3512
3513The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3514when linking for 68K targets.
3515
3516@table @gcctabopt
3517
3518@kindex --got
3519@item --got=@var{type}
3520This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3521@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3522@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3523Info entry for @file{ld}.
3524
3525@end table
3526
3527@c man end
3528@end ifset
3529
833794fc
MR
3530@ifset MIPS
3531@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3532
3533@c man begin OPTIONS
3534
3535The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3536generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3537linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3538
3539@table @gcctabopt
3540
3541@kindex --insn32
3542@item --insn32
3543@kindex --no-insn32
3544@itemx --no-insn32
3545These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3546generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3547or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
354832-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3549used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3550possible.
3551
8b10b0b3
MR
3552@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3553@item --ignore-branch-isa
3554@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3555@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3556These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3557transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3558accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3559is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3560instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3561equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3562calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3563a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3564an error.
3565
3734320d
MF
3566@kindex --compact-branches
3567@item --compact-branches
3568@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3569@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3570These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3571in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3572
833794fc
MR
3573@end table
3574
3575@c man end
3576@end ifset
3577
fa1477dc
SC
3578
3579@ifset PDP11
3580@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3581
3582@c man begin OPTIONS
3583
3584For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3585produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3586for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3587targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3588defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3589here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3590
3591@table @gcctabopt
3592
3593@kindex -N
3594@item -N
3595@kindex --omagic
3596@itemx --omagic
3597
3598Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3599indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3600shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3601writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3602the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3603programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3604from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3605
3606@kindex -n
3607@item -n
3608@kindex --nmagic
3609@itemx --nmagic
3610
3611Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3612indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3613be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3614file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3615byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3616a @emph{pure executable} format.
3617
3618@kindex -z
3619@item -z
3620@kindex --imagic
3621@itemx --imagic
3622
3623Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3624indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3625data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3626instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3627larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3628to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3629shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3630option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3631and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3632this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3633executable} format.
3634
3635@kindex --no-omagic
3636@item --no-omagic
3637
3638Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3639
3640@end table
3641
3642@c man end
3643@end ifset
3644
252b5132
RH
3645@ifset UsesEnvVars
3646@node Environment
3647@section Environment Variables
3648
0285c67d
NC
3649@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3650
560e09e9 3651You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3652@ifclear SingleFormat
3653@code{GNUTARGET},
3654@end ifclear
3655@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3656
36f63dca 3657@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3658@kindex GNUTARGET
3659@cindex default input format
3660@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3661use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3662of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3663@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3664of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3665attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3666this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3667there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3668object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3669BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3670in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3671@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3672
3673@kindex LDEMULATION
3674@cindex default emulation
3675@cindex emulation, default
3676@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3677@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3678behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3679available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3680the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3681variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3682linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3683
3684@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3685@cindex demangling, default
3686Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3687@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3688default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3689a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3690may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3691options.
3692
0285c67d
NC
3693@c man end
3694@end ifset
3695
252b5132
RH
3696@node Scripts
3697@chapter Linker Scripts
3698
3699@cindex scripts
3700@cindex linker scripts
3701@cindex command files
3702Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3703written in the linker command language.
3704
3705The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3706the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3707the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3708more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3709direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3710described below.
3711
3712The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3713yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3714linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3715to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3716such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3717
3718You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3719line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3720default linker script.
3721
3722You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3723to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3724Linker Scripts}.
3725
3726@menu
3727* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3728* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3729* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3730* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3731* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3732* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3733* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3734* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3735* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3736* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3737* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3738@end menu
3739
3740@node Basic Script Concepts
3741@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3742@cindex linker script concepts
3743We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3744describe the linker script language.
3745
3746The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3747file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3748@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3749The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3750purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3751among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3752section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3753in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3754
3755Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3756also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3757contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3758the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3759A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3760area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3761loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3762which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3763of debugging information.
3764
3765Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3766first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3767the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3768@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3769section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3770same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3771is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3772(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3773based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3774RAM address would be the VMA.
3775
3776You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3777program with the @samp{-h} option.
3778
3779Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3780@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3781has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3782information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3783will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3784static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3785referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3786
3787You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3788program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3789option.
3790
3791@node Script Format
3792@section Linker Script Format
3793@cindex linker script format
3794Linker scripts are text files.
3795
3796You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3797either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3798symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3799generally ignored.
3800
3801Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3802If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3803otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3804double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3805file name.
3806
3807You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3808@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3809to whitespace.
3810
3811@node Simple Example
3812@section Simple Linker Script Example
3813@cindex linker script example
3814@cindex example of linker script
3815Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3816
3817The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3818@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3819memory layout of the output file.
3820
3821The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3822describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3823code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3824@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3825Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3826your input files.
3827
3828For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
38290x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3830linker script which will do that:
3831@smallexample
3832SECTIONS
3833@{
3834 . = 0x10000;
3835 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3836 . = 0x8000000;
3837 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3838 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3839@}
3840@end smallexample
3841
3842You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3843followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3844descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3845
252b5132
RH
3846The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3847sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3848counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3849other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3850current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3851incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3852@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3853
3854The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3855required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3856after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3857which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3858wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3859means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3860
3861Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3862@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3863@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3864
3865The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3866the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3867at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3868output section, the value of the location counter will be
3869@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3870effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3871immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3872
3873The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3874alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3875example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3876sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3877may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3878sections.
3879
3880That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3881
3882@node Simple Commands
3883@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3884@cindex linker script simple commands
3885In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3886
3887@menu
3888* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3889* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3890@ifclear SingleFormat
3891* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3892@end ifclear
3893
4a93e180 3894* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3895* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3896@end menu
3897
3898@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3899@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3900@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3901@cindex start of execution
3902@cindex first instruction
3903@cindex entry point
3904The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3905point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3906entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3907@smallexample
3908ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3909@end smallexample
3910
3911There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3912entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3913stopping when one of them succeeds:
3914@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3915@item
252b5132 3916the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3917@item
252b5132 3918the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3919@item
a094d01f 3920the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3921targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3922check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3923@item
5226a6a8
NC
3924the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3925executable is being created - the code section is usually
3926@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 3927@item
252b5132
RH
3928The address @code{0}.
3929@end itemize
3930
3931@node File Commands
36f63dca 3932@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3933@cindex linker script file commands
3934Several linker script commands deal with files.
3935
3936@table @code
3937@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3938@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3939@cindex including a linker script
3940Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3941be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3942with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
394310 levels deep.
3944
4006703d
NS
3945You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3946@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3947
252b5132
RH
3948@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3949@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3950@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3951@cindex input files in linker scripts
3952@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3953@cindex linker script input object files
3954The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3955in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3956
3957For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3958a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3959then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3960
3961In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3962script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3963
e3f2db7f
AO
3964In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3965with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3966located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3967for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3968@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3969filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3970@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3971
3972If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3973the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3974found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3975not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3976path.
252b5132 3977
ff5dcc92 3978If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3979name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3980@samp{-l}.
3981
3982When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3983files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3984script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3985
3986@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3987@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3988@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3989@cindex grouping input files
3990The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3991files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3992new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3993in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3994
b717d30e
JJ
3995@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3996@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3997@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3998This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3999commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4000as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4001with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4002when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4003@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4004and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4005setting afterwards.
4006
252b5132
RH
4007@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4008@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4009@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4010The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4011@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4012@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4013Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4014precedence.
4015
4016You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4017output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4018
4019@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4020@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4021@cindex library search path in linker script
4022@cindex archive search path in linker script
4023@cindex search path in linker script
4024The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4025@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4026@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4027on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4028are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4029the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4030
4031@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4032@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4033@cindex first input file
4034The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4035that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4036though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4037when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4038first file.
4039@end table
4040
4041@ifclear SingleFormat
4042@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4043@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4044A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4045
4046@table @code
4047@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4048@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4049@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4050@cindex output file format in linker script
4051The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4052output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4053exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4054(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4055line option takes precedence.
4056
4057You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4058formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4059This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4060desired endianness.
4061
4062If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4063will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4064output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4065used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4066
4067For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4068command:
4069@smallexample
4070OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4071@end smallexample
4072This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4073@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4074option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4075format.
4076
4077@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4078@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4079@cindex input file format in linker script
4080The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4081files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4082This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4083(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4084is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4085command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4086@end table
4087@end ifclear
4088
4a93e180
NC
4089@node REGION_ALIAS
4090@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4091@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4092@cindex region alias
4093@cindex region names
4094
4095Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4096@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4097
4098@smallexample
4099REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4100@end smallexample
4101
4102The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4103memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4104to memory regions. An example follows.
4105
4106Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4107memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4108that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4109non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4110access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4111read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4112sections:
4113
4114@itemize @bullet
4115@item
4116@code{.text} program code;
4117@item
4118@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4119@item
4120@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4121@item
4122@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4123@end itemize
4124
4125The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4126part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4127output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4128systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4129@code{C}:
4130@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4131@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4132@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4133@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4134@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4135@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4136@end multitable
4137The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4138loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4139the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4140the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4141
4142The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4143includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4144memory layout:
4145@smallexample
4146INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4147
4148SECTIONS
4149 @{
4150 .text :
4151 @{
4152 *(.text)
4153 @} > REGION_TEXT
4154 .rodata :
4155 @{
4156 *(.rodata)
4157 rodata_end = .;
4158 @} > REGION_RODATA
4159 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4160 @{
4161 data_start = .;
4162 *(.data)
4163 @} > REGION_DATA
4164 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4165 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4166 .bss :
4167 @{
4168 *(.bss)
4169 @} > REGION_BSS
4170 @}
4171@end smallexample
4172
4173Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4174regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4175variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4176@table @code
4177@item A
4178Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4179@smallexample
4180MEMORY
4181 @{
4182 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4183 @}
4184
4185REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4186REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4187REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4188REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4189@end smallexample
4190@item B
4191Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4192into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4193@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4194@smallexample
4195MEMORY
4196 @{
4197 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4198 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4199 @}
4200
4201REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4202REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4203REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4204REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4205@end smallexample
4206@item C
4207Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4208@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4209initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4210system start into the @code{RAM}.
4211@smallexample
4212MEMORY
4213 @{
4214 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4215 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4216 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4217 @}
4218
4219REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4220REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4221REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4222REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4223@end smallexample
4224@end table
4225
4226It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4227@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4228necessary:
4229@smallexample
4230#include <string.h>
4231
4232extern char data_start [];
4233extern char data_size [];
4234extern char data_load_start [];
4235
4236void copy_data(void)
4237@{
4238 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4239 @{
4240 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4241 @}
4242@}
4243@end smallexample
4244
252b5132 4245@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4246@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4247There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4248
4249@table @code
4250@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4251@kindex ASSERT
4252@cindex assertion in linker script
4253Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4254with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4255
fd1c4238
NC
4256Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4257take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4258inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4259for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4260symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4261
4262@smallexample
4263 .stack :
4264 @{
4265 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4266 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4267 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4268 @}
4269@end smallexample
4270
4271will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4272PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4273can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4274
4275@smallexample
4276 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4277 .stack :
4278 @{
4279 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4280 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4281 @}
4282@end smallexample
4283
4284will work.
4285
252b5132
RH
4286@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4287@kindex EXTERN
4288@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4289Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4290symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4291modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4292each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4293command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4294
4295@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4296@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4297@cindex common allocation in linker script
4298This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4299to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4300output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4301
4818e05f
AM
4302@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4303@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4304@cindex common allocation in linker script
4305This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4306command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4307to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4308
7bdf4127
AB
4309@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4310@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4311@cindex group allocation in linker script
4312@cindex section groups
4313@cindex COMDAT
4314This command has the same effect as the
4315@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4316@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4317and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4318specified (@samp{-r}).
4319
53d25da6
AM
4320@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4321@kindex INSERT
4322@cindex insert user script into default script
4323This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4324augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4325inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4326@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4327default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4328sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4329linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4330insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4331linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4332default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4333of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4334to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4335is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4336
4337@smallexample
4338SECTIONS
4339@{
4340 OVERLAY :
4341 @{
4342 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4343 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4344 @}
4345@}
4346INSERT AFTER .text;
4347@end smallexample
4348
252b5132
RH
4349@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4350@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4351@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4352This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4353references among certain output sections.
4354
4355In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4356using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4357will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4358errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4359a function defined in the other section.
4360
4361The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4362@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4363an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4364@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4365names.
4366
cdf96953
MF
4367@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4368@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4369@cindex cross references
4370This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4371references to one section from a list of other sections.
4372
4373The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4374output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4375a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4376there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4377must never call back.
4378
4379The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4380The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4381If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4382the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4383status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4384names, not input section names.
4385
252b5132
RH
4386@ifclear SingleFormat
4387@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4388@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4389@cindex machine architecture
4390@cindex architecture
4391Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4392of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4393architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4394the @samp{-f} option.
4395@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4396
4397@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4398@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4399This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4400@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4401in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4402@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4403@end table
4404
4405@node Assignments
4406@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4407@cindex assignment in scripts
4408@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4409@cindex variables, defining
4410You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4411the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4412
4413@menu
4414* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4415* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4416* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4417* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4418* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4419@end menu
4420
4421@node Simple Assignments
4422@subsection Simple Assignments
4423
4424You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4425
4426@table @code
4427@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4428@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4429@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4430@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4431@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4432@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4433@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4434@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4435@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4436@end table
4437
4438The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4439@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4440defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4441
4442The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4443may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4444
4445The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4446
4447Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4448
4449You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4450statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4451section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4452
4453The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4454expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4455
4456Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4457assignments may be used:
4458
4459@smallexample
4460floating_point = 0;
4461SECTIONS
4462@{
4463 .text :
4464 @{
4465 *(.text)
4466 _etext = .;
4467 @}
156e34dd 4468 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4469 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4470@}
4471@end smallexample
4472@noindent
4473In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4474zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4475the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4476defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4477upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4478
eb8476a6
MR
4479@node HIDDEN
4480@subsection HIDDEN
4481@cindex HIDDEN
4482For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4483exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4484
4485Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4486@code{HIDDEN}:
4487
4488@smallexample
4489HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4490SECTIONS
4491@{
4492 .text :
4493 @{
4494 *(.text)
4495 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4496 @}
4497 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4498 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4499@}
4500@end smallexample
4501@noindent
4502In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4503
252b5132
RH
4504@node PROVIDE
4505@subsection PROVIDE
4506@cindex PROVIDE
4507In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4508only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4509the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4510@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4511@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4512@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4513@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4514@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4515
4516Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4517@smallexample
4518SECTIONS
4519@{
4520 .text :
4521 @{
4522 *(.text)
4523 _etext = .;
4524 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4525 @}
4526@}
4527@end smallexample
4528
4529In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4530underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4531on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4532underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4533If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4534linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4535
b0daac83
NC
4536Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4537defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4538that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4539when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4540@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4541
7af8e998
L
4542@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4543@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4544@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4545Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4546hidden and won't be exported.
4547
73ae6183
NC
4548@node Source Code Reference
4549@subsection Source Code Reference
4550
4551Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4552intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4553a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4554symbol that does not have a value.
4555
4556Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4557transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4558stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4559prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4560mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4561of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4562variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4563linker script variable might be referred to as:
4564
4565@smallexample
4566 extern int foo;
4567@end smallexample
4568
4569But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4570
4571@smallexample
4572 _foo = 1000;
4573@end smallexample
4574
4575In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4576transformation has taken place.
4577
4578When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4579things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4580in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4581second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4582table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4583contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4584value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4585
4586@smallexample
4587 int foo = 1000;
4588@end smallexample
4589
10bf6894 4590creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4591holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4592number 1000 is initially stored.
4593
4594When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4595first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4596memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4597So:
4598
4599@smallexample
4600 foo = 1;
4601@end smallexample
4602
4603looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4604associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4605address. Whereas:
4606
4607@smallexample
4608 int * a = & foo;
4609@end smallexample
4610
10bf6894 4611looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4612and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4613the variable @samp{a}.
4614
4615Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4616the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4617an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4618
4619@smallexample
4620 foo = 1000;
4621@end smallexample
4622
4623creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4624the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4625address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4626linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4627access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4628
4629Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4630you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4631use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4632section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4633linker script contains these declarations:
4634
4635@smallexample
4636@group
4637 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4638 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4639 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4640@end group
4641@end smallexample
4642
4643Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4644
4645@smallexample
4646@group
4647 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4648
73ae6183
NC
4649 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4650@end group
4651@end smallexample
4652
4653Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4654Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4655arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4656
4657@smallexample
4658@group
4659 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4660
4661 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4662@end group
4663@end smallexample
4664
4665Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4666operators.
73ae6183 4667
252b5132 4668@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4669@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4670@kindex SECTIONS
4671The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4672into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4673
4674The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4675@smallexample
4676SECTIONS
4677@{
4678 @var{sections-command}
4679 @var{sections-command}
4680 @dots{}
4681@}
4682@end smallexample
4683
4684Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4685
4686@itemize @bullet
4687@item
4688an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4689@item
4690a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4691@item
4692an output section description
4693@item
4694an overlay description
4695@end itemize
4696
4697The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4698@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4699those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4700understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4701the layout of the output file.
4702
4703Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4704below.
4705
4706If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4707linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4708section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4709input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4710example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4711in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4712
4713@menu
4714* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4715* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4716* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4717* Input Section:: Input section description
4718* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4719* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4720* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4721* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4722* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4723@end menu
4724
4725@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4726@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4727The full description of an output section looks like this:
4728@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4729@group
7e7d5768 4730@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4731 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4732 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4733 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4734 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4735 @{
4736 @var{output-section-command}
4737 @var{output-section-command}
4738 @dots{}
abc9061b 4739 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4740@end group
4741@end smallexample
4742
4743Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4744
4745The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4746name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4747The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4748the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4749The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4750
4751Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4752
4753@itemize @bullet
4754@item
4755a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4756@item
4757an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4758@item
4759data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4760@item
4761a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4762@end itemize
4763
4764@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4765@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4766@cindex name, section
4767@cindex section name
4768The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4769meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4770support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4771must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4772example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4773output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4774names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4775quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4776characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4777commas must be quoted.
4778
4779The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4780Discarding}.
4781
4782@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4783@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4784@cindex address, section
4785@cindex section address
4786The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4787address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4788is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4789
4790If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4791section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4792to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4793alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4794contained within the output section.
4795
4796The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4797
4798@itemize @bullet
4799@item
4800If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4801is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4802in that region.
4803
4804@item
4805If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4806regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4807section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4808be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4809
4810@item
4811If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4812the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4813counter.
4814@end itemize
4815
4816@noindent
4817For example:
4818
252b5132
RH
4819@smallexample
4820.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4821@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4822
252b5132
RH
4823@noindent
4824and
ea5cae92 4825
252b5132
RH
4826@smallexample
4827.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4828@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4829
252b5132
RH
4830@noindent
4831are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4832@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4833counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4834counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4835input sections.
252b5132
RH
4836
4837The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4838For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4839so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4840do something like this:
4841@smallexample
4842.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4843@end smallexample
4844@noindent
4845This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4846aligned upward to the specified value.
4847
4848Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4849location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4850sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4851
4852@node Input Section
36f63dca 4853@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4854@cindex input sections
4855@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4856The most common output section command is an input section description.
4857
4858The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4859You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4860in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4861map the input files into your memory layout.
4862
4863@menu
4864* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4865* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4866* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4867* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4868* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4869@end menu
4870
4871@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4872@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4873@cindex input section basics
4874An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4875by a list of section names in parentheses.
4876
4877The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4878describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4879
4880The most common input section description is to include all input
4881sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4882include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4883@smallexample
4884*(.text)
4885@end smallexample
4886@noindent
18625d54 4887Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4888@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4889of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4890match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4891example:
252b5132 4892@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4893EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4894@end smallexample
4895@noindent
4896will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4897and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4898placed inside the section list, for example:
4899@smallexample
b4346c09 4900*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4901@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4902@noindent
4903The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4904two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4905more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4906
4907There are two ways to include more than one section:
4908@smallexample
4909*(.text .rdata)
4910*(.text) *(.rdata)
4911@end smallexample
4912@noindent
4913The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4914@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4915first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4916they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4917@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4918@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4919
8f1732fc
AB
4920When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4921is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4922immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4923@smallexample
4924*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4925@end smallexample
4926@noindent
4927will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4928@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4929from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4930exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4931could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4932@smallexample
4933*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4934@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4935@noindent
4936Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4937before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4938all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4939@smallexample
4940EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4941@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4942
252b5132
RH
4943You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4944You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4945needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4946@smallexample
4947data.o(.data)
4948@end smallexample
4949
ae17ab41
CM
4950To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4951of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4952
4953Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4954
4955@smallexample
4956@group
4957SECTIONS @{
4958 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4959 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4960@}
4961@end group
4962@end smallexample
4963
4964In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4965input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4966@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4967@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4968whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4969
967928e9
AM
4970You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4971matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4972with no whitespace around the colon.
4973
4974@table @samp
4975@item archive:file
4976matches file within archive
4977@item archive:
4978matches the whole archive
4979@item :file
4980matches file but not one in an archive
4981@end table
4982
4983Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4984wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4985single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4986@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4987within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4988also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4989other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4990from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4991command.
4992
252b5132
RH
4993If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4994the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4995commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4996@smallexample
4997data.o
4998@end smallexample
4999
967928e9
AM
5000When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5001and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5002characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5003name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5004did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5005though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5006@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5007the archive search path.
5008
5009@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5010@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5011@cindex input section wildcards
5012@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5013@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5014@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5015In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5016name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5017
5018The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5019pattern for the file name.
5020
5021The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5022
5023@table @samp
5024@item *
5025matches any number of characters
5026@item ?
5027matches any single character
5028@item [@var{chars}]
5029matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5030character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5031@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5032@item \
5033quotes the following character
5034@end table
5035
252b5132
RH
5036File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5037specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5038does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5039
5040If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5041appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5042will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5043sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5044@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5045@smallexample
5046.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5047.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5048@end smallexample
5049
bcaa7b3e 5050@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5051Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5052in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5053this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5054pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5055@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5056into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5057
bcaa7b3e 5058@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5059@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5060@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5061alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5062alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5063needed.
bcaa7b3e 5064
02ecc8e9 5065@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5066@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5067@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5068numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5069section name before placing them in the output file. In
5070@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5071the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5072@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5073
bcaa7b3e
L
5074@cindex SORT
5075@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5076
5077When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5078can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5079
5080@enumerate
5081@item
5082@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5083It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5084sections have the same name.
5085@item
5086@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5087It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5088sections have the same alignment.
5089@item
c0065db7 5090@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5091treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5092@item
5093@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5094is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5095@item
5096All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5097@end enumerate
5098
a05a5b64 5099When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5100section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5101takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5102
5103If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5104command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5105treated as nested sorting command.
5106
5107@enumerate
5108@item
5109@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5110@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5111@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5112@item
5113@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5114@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5115@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5116@end enumerate
5117
5118If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5119command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5120
eda680f8 5121@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5122@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5123section sorting option.
5124
252b5132
RH
5125If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5126@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5127precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5128
5129This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5130files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5131sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5132The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5133with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5134linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5135@smallexample
5136@group
5137SECTIONS @{
5138 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5139 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5140 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5141 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5142@}
5143@end group
5144@end smallexample
5145
5146@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5147@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5148@cindex common symbol placement
5149@cindex uninitialized data placement
5150A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5151file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5152linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5153named @samp{COMMON}.
5154
5155You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5156other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5157particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5158input files are placed in another section.
5159
5160In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5161@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5162@smallexample
5163.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5164@end smallexample
5165
5166@cindex scommon section
5167@cindex small common symbols
5168Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5169example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5170symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5171different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5172the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5173symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5174to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5175locations.
5176
5177@cindex [COMMON]
5178You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5179notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5180@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5181
5182@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5183@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5184@cindex KEEP
5185@cindex garbage collection
5186When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5187it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5188This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5189with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5190@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5191
5192@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5193@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5194The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5195to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5196start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5197@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5198follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5199@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5200@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5201All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5202files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5203
5204@smallexample
5205@group
5206SECTIONS @{
5207 outputa 0x10000 :
5208 @{
5209 all.o
5210 foo.o (.input1)
5211 @}
36f63dca
NC
5212@end group
5213@group
252b5132
RH
5214 outputb :
5215 @{
5216 foo.o (.input2)
5217 foo1.o (.input1)
5218 @}
36f63dca
NC
5219@end group
5220@group
252b5132
RH
5221 outputc :
5222 @{
5223 *(.input1)
5224 *(.input2)
5225 @}
5226@}
5227@end group
a1ab1d2a 5228@end smallexample
252b5132 5229
cbd0eecf
L
5230If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5231and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5232automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5233__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5234indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5235respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5236C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5237
252b5132 5238@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5239@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5240@cindex data
5241@cindex section data
5242@cindex output section data
5243@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5244@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5245@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5246@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5247@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5248You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5249@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5250an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5251parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5252value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5253counter.
5254
5255The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5256store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5257bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5258stored.
5259
5260For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5261of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5262@smallexample
5263BYTE(1)
5264LONG(addr)
5265@end smallexample
5266
5267When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5268same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5269target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5270@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5271@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5272
5273If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5274which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5275When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5276true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5277endianness of the first input object file.
5278
36f63dca 5279Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5280between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5281@smallexample
5282SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5283@end smallexample
5284whereas this will work:
5285@smallexample
5286SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5287@end smallexample
5288
252b5132
RH
5289@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5290@cindex holes, filling
5291@cindex unspecified memory
5292You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5293current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5294otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5295gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5296with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5297necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5298point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5299than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5300different parts of an output section.
5301
5302This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5303value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5304@smallexample
563e308f 5305FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5306@end smallexample
5307
5308The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5309section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5310part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5311entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5312precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5313expression.
252b5132
RH
5314
5315@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5316@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5317There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5318commands.
5319
5320@table @code
5321@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5322@cindex input filename symbols
5323@cindex filename symbols
5324@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5325The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5326The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5327file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5328the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5329
5330This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5331normally used for any other object file format.
5332
5333@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5334@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5335@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5336@item CONSTRUCTORS
5337When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5338unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5339destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5340arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5341automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5342For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5343linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5344@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5345ignored for other object file formats.
5346
5347The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5348constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5349Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5350the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5351first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5352of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5353compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5354formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5355@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5356the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5357destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5358@code{exit}.
5359
5360For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5361arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5362addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5363and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5364linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5365runtime code expects to see.
5366
5367@smallexample
5368 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5369 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5370 *(.ctors)
5371 LONG(0)
5372 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5373 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5374 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5375 *(.dtors)
5376 LONG(0)
5377 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5378@end smallexample
5379
5380If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5381which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5382are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5383are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5384command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5385@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5386@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5387@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5388
5389Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5390and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5391need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5392scripts.
5393
5394@end table
5395
5396@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5397@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5398@cindex discarding sections
5399@cindex sections, discarding
5400@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5401The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5402This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5403may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5404@smallexample
49c13adb 5405.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5406@end smallexample
5407@noindent
5408will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5409@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5410sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5411space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5412too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5413space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5414@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5415@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5416This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5417
a0976ea4 5418The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5419on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5420symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5421the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5422section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5423
5424@cindex /DISCARD/
5425The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5426input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5427section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5428
99fabbc9
JL
5429This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5430@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5431garbage collection.
5432
a2e098c3
NC
5433Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5434discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5435members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5436Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5437
252b5132 5438@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5439@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5440@cindex output section attributes
5441We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5442like this:
0c71d759 5443
252b5132 5444@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5445@group
7e7d5768 5446@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5447 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5448 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5449 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5450 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5451 @{
5452 @var{output-section-command}
5453 @var{output-section-command}
5454 @dots{}
562d3460 5455 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5456@end group
5457@end smallexample
0c71d759 5458
252b5132
RH
5459We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5460@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5461remaining section attributes.
5462
a1ab1d2a 5463@menu
252b5132
RH
5464* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5465* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5466* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5467* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5468* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5469* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5470* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5471* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5472@end menu
5473
5474@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5475@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5476Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5477parentheses. The following types are defined:
5478
5479@table @code
5480@item NOLOAD
5481The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5482loaded into memory when the program is run.
6b86da53
LB
5483@item READONLY
5484The section should be marked as read-only.
252b5132
RH
5485@item DSECT
5486@itemx COPY
5487@itemx INFO
5488@itemx OVERLAY
5489These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5490rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5491marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5492section when the program is run.
5493@end table
5494
5495@kindex NOLOAD
5496@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5497@cindex loading, preventing
5498The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5499the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5500the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5501@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5502need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5503@smallexample
5504@group
5505SECTIONS @{
5506 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5507 @dots{}
5508@}
5509@end group
5510@end smallexample
5511
5512@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5513@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5514@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5515@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5516@cindex load address
5517@cindex section load address
5518Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5519@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5520@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5521specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5522address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5523
ea5cae92
NC
5524The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5525specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5526takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5527load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5528region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5529
5530If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5531section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5532load address:
5533
5534@itemize @bullet
5535@item
5536If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5537the LMA address as well.
5538
5539@item
5540If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5541
5542@item
5543Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5544with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5545section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5546VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5547the last section in the located region.
5548
5549@item
5550If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5551that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5552
5553@item
5554If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5555section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5556@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5557
5558@cindex ROM initialized data
5559@cindex initialized data in ROM
5560This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5561example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5562called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5563@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5564even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5565uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5566defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5567counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5568
5569@smallexample
5570@group
5571SECTIONS
5572 @{
5573 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5574 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5575 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5576 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5577 .bss 0x3000 :
5578 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5579@}
5580@end group
5581@end smallexample
5582
5583The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5584this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5585the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5586how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5587script.
5588
5589@smallexample
5590@group
5591extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5592char *src = &_etext;
5593char *dst = &_data;
5594
ea5cae92
NC
5595/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5596while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5597 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5598
ea5cae92 5599/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5600for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5601 *dst = 0;
5602@end group
5603@end smallexample
5604
bbf115d3
L
5605@node Forced Output Alignment
5606@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5607@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5608@cindex forcing output section alignment
5609@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5610You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5611alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5612intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5613
7e7d5768
AM
5614@node Forced Input Alignment
5615@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5616@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5617@cindex forcing input section alignment
5618@cindex input section alignment
5619You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5620SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5621sections, whether larger or smaller.
5622
0c71d759
NC
5623@node Output Section Constraint
5624@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5625@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5626@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5627@cindex constraints on output sections
5628You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5629of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5630read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5631@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5632
252b5132 5633@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5634@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5635@kindex >@var{region}
5636@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5637@cindex memory regions and sections
5638You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5639using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5640
5641Here is a simple example:
5642@smallexample
5643@group
5644MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5645SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5646@end group
5647@end smallexample
5648
5649@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5650@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5651@kindex :@var{phdr}
5652@cindex section, assigning to program header
5653@cindex program headers and sections
5654You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5655using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5656one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5657assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5658@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5659linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5660
5661Here is a simple example:
5662@smallexample
5663@group
5664PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5665SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5666@end group
5667@end smallexample
5668
5669@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5670@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5671@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5672@cindex section fill pattern
5673@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5674You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5675@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5676(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5677within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5678alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5679necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5680of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5681an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5682fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5683other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5684pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5685expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5686
5687You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5688output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5689
5690Here is a simple example:
5691@smallexample
5692@group
563e308f 5693SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5694@end group
5695@end smallexample
5696
5697@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5698@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5699@kindex OVERLAY
5700@cindex overlays
5701An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5702are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5703the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5704copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5705required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5706can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5707than another.
5708
5709Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5710@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5711output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5712command is as follows:
5713@smallexample
5714@group
5715OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5716 @{
5717 @var{secname1}
5718 @{
5719 @var{output-section-command}
5720 @var{output-section-command}
5721 @dots{}
5722 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5723 @var{secname2}
5724 @{
5725 @var{output-section-command}
5726 @var{output-section-command}
5727 @dots{}
5728 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5729 @dots{}
abc9061b 5730 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5731@end group
5732@end smallexample
5733
5734Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5735section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5736section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5737those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5738except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5739sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5740
abc9061b
CC
5741The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5742the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5743
252b5132
RH
5744The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5745addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5746memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5747whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5748and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5749and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5750
56dd11f0
NC
5751If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5752references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5753the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5754sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5755@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5756
5757For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5758provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5759defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5760@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5761the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5762within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5763symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5764
5765At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5766the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5767
5768Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5769@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5770@smallexample
5771@group
5772 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5773 @{
5774 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5775 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5776 @}
5777@end group
5778@end smallexample
5779@noindent
5780This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5781address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5782@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5783following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5784@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5785@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5786
5787C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5788like the following.
5789
5790@smallexample
5791@group
5792 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5793 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5794 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5795@end group
5796@end smallexample
5797
5798Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5799everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5800example could have been written identically as follows.
5801
5802@smallexample
5803@group
5804 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5805 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5806 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5807 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5808 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5809 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5810 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5811@end group
5812@end smallexample
5813
5814@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5815@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5816@kindex MEMORY
5817@cindex memory regions
5818@cindex regions of memory
5819@cindex allocating memory
5820@cindex discontinuous memory
5821The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5822memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5823
5824The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5825memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5826may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5827can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5828set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5829regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5830around to fit into the available regions.
5831
127fcdff
AB
5832A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5833however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5834specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5835@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5836@smallexample
5837@group
a1ab1d2a 5838MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5839 @{
5840 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5841 @dots{}
5842 @}
5843@end group
5844@end smallexample
5845
5846The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5847region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5848Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5849with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5850must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5851add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5852command.
252b5132
RH
5853
5854@cindex memory region attributes
5855The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5856whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5857not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5858@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5859section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5860the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5861them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5862
5863The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5864@table @samp
5865@item R
5866Read-only section
5867@item W
5868Read/write section
5869@item X
5870Executable section
5871@item A
5872Allocatable section
5873@item I
5874Initialized section
5875@item L
5876Same as @samp{I}
5877@item !
c09e9a8c 5878Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5879@end table
5880
81c688d5 5881If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5882@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5883attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5884unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5885not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5886string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5887or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5888the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5889
5890@kindex ORIGIN =
5891@kindex o =
5892@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5893The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5894the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5895cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5896abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5897@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5898
5899@kindex LENGTH =
5900@kindex len =
5901@kindex l =
5902The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5903region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5904be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5905@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5906
5907In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5908available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5909and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5910linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5911is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5912or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5913explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5914region.
5915
5916@smallexample
5917@group
a1ab1d2a 5918MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5919 @{
5920 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5921 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5922 @}
5923@end group
5924@end smallexample
5925
5926Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5927specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5928@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5929a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5930output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5931was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5932the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5933output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5934region, the linker will issue an error message.
5935
3ec57632 5936It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5937expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5938@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5939
5940@smallexample
5941@group
c0065db7 5942 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5943@end group
5944@end smallexample
5945
252b5132
RH
5946@node PHDRS
5947@section PHDRS Command
5948@kindex PHDRS
5949@cindex program headers
5950@cindex ELF program headers
5951@cindex program segments
5952@cindex segments, ELF
5953The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5954@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5955loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5956program with the @samp{-p} option.
5957
5958When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5959reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5960program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5961This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5962interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5963
5964The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5965in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5966precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5967the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5968not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5969
5970The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5971generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5972ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5973
5974This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5975@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5976
5977@smallexample
5978@group
5979PHDRS
5980@{
5981 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5982 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5983@}
5984@end group
5985@end smallexample
5986
5987The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5988of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5989header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5990with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5991must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5992is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5993
5994Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5995system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5996specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5997sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5998attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5999Section Phdr}.
6000
6001It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6002merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6003repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6004contain the section.
6005
6006If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6007then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6008not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6009convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6010placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6011default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6012segment at all.
6013
6014@kindex FILEHDR
6015@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6016You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6017the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6018The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6019file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6020include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6021segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6022these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6023
6024The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6025value of the keyword.
6026
6027@table @asis
6028@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6029Indicates an unused program header.
6030
6031@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6032Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6033the file.
6034
6035@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6036Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6037
6038@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6039Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6040found.
6041
6042@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6043Indicates a segment holding note information.
6044
6045@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6046A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6047ABI.
6048
6049@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6050Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6051
1a9ccd70
NC
6052@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6053Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6054
252b5132
RH
6055@item @var{expression}
6056An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6057be used for types not defined above.
6058@end table
6059
6060You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6061in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6062@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6063Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6064output section attribute.
6065
6066The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6067which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6068explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6069an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6070header.
6071
6072Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6073headers used on a native ELF system.
6074
6075@example
6076@group
6077PHDRS
6078@{
6079 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6080 interp PT_INTERP ;
6081 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6082 data PT_LOAD ;
6083 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6084@}
6085
6086SECTIONS
6087@{
6088 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6089 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6090 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6091 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6092 @dots{}
6093 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6094 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6095 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6096 @dots{}
6097@}
6098@end group
6099@end example
6100
6101@node VERSION
6102@section VERSION Command
6103@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6104@cindex symbol versions
6105@cindex version script
6106@cindex versions of symbols
6107The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6108only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6109symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6110a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6111shared library.
6112
6113You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6114you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6115also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6116
6117The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6118@smallexample
6119VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6120@end smallexample
6121
6122The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6123Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6124version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6125version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6126version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6127scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6128library.
6129
6130The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6131examples.
6132
6133@smallexample
6134VERS_1.1 @{
6135 global:
6136 foo1;
6137 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6138 old*;
6139 original*;
6140 new*;
252b5132
RH
6141@};
6142
6143VERS_1.2 @{
6144 foo2;
6145@} VERS_1.1;
6146
6147VERS_2.0 @{
6148 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6149 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6150 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6151 "f(int, double)";
6152 @};
252b5132
RH
6153@} VERS_1.2;
6154@end smallexample
6155
6156This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6157version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6158The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6159a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6160of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6161symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6162is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6163in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6164However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6165name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6166
6167Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6168depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6169to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6170
6171Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6172depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6173and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6174
6175When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6176specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6177unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6178unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6179somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6180wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6181wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6182set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6183ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6184
6185The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6186they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6187could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6188However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6189
0f6bf451 6190Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6191in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6192symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6193won't.
6194
6195@smallexample
7c9c73be 6196@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6197@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6198
252b5132
RH
6199When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6200symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6201requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6202shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6203loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6204linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6205application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6206way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6207all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6208search for each symbol reference.
6209
6210The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6211doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6212that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6213functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6214the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6215required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6216that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6217versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6218the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6219
6220There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6221first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6222source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6223script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6224maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6225@smallexample
6226__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6227@end smallexample
6228@noindent
6229in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6230be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6231The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6232@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6233takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6234
6235The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6236function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6237an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6238version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6239linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6240
6241To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6242source file. Here is an example:
6243
6244@smallexample
6245__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6246__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6247__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6248__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6249@end smallexample
6250
6251In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6252unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6253example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6254@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6255
6256When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6257some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6258this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6259@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6260declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6261you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6262
6263If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6264within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6265(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6266specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6267
cb840a31
L
6268You can also specify the language in the version script:
6269
6270@smallexample
6271VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6272@end smallexample
6273
c0065db7 6274The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6275The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6276demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6277patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6278@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6279
86043bbb
MM
6280Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6281described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6282or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6283the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6284whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6285cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6286might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6287should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6288expect when you upgrade.
6289
252b5132
RH
6290@node Expressions
6291@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6292@cindex expressions
6293@cindex arithmetic
6294The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6295that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6296places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6297evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6298size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6299otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6300
6301You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6302
6303The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6304expressions.
6305
6306@menu
6307* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6308* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6309* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6310* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6311* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6312* Operators:: Operators
6313* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6314* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6315* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6316@end menu
6317
6318@node Constants
6319@subsection Constants
6320@cindex integer notation
6321@cindex constants in linker scripts
6322All constants are integers.
6323
6324As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6325octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6326hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6327@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6328@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6329value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6330
6331@cindex scaled integers
6332@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6333@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6334@cindex suffixes for integers
6335@cindex integer suffixes
6336In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6337constant by
6338@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6339@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6340@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6341@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6342@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6343@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6344@tex
6345${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6346@end tex
6347@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6348respectively. For example, the following
6349all refer to the same quantity:
6350
252b5132 6351@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6352_fourk_1 = 4K;
6353_fourk_2 = 4096;
6354_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6355_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6356@end smallexample
6357
8a308ae8
NC
6358Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6359conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6360
0c71d759
NC
6361@node Symbolic Constants
6362@subsection Symbolic Constants
6363@cindex symbolic constants
6364@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6365It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6366the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6367
6368@table @code
6369@item MAXPAGESIZE
6370@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6371The target's maximum page size.
6372
6373@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6374@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6375The target's default page size.
6376@end table
6377
6378So for example:
6379
6380@smallexample
9d5777a3 6381 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6382@end smallexample
6383
6384will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6385supported by the target.
6386
252b5132
RH
6387@node Symbols
6388@subsection Symbol Names
6389@cindex symbol names
6390@cindex names
6391@cindex quoted symbol names
6392@kindex "
6393Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6394and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6395Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6396specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6397keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6398@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6399"SECTION" = 9;
6400"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6401@end smallexample
6402
6403Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6404to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6405whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6406
ecca9871
L
6407@node Orphan Sections
6408@subsection Orphan Sections
6409@cindex orphan
6410Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6411are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6412script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6413output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6414in which to place the orphaned input section.
6415
6416If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6417an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6418placed at the end of that output section.
6419
6420If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6421sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6422name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6423orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6424one new output section.
6425
6426If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6427then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6428in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6429linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6430attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6431sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6432support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6433
a05a5b64
TP
6434The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6435(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6436output sections an orphan is placed in.
6437
252b5132
RH
6438@node Location Counter
6439@subsection The Location Counter
6440@kindex .
6441@cindex dot
6442@cindex location counter
6443@cindex current output location
6444The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6445current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6446location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6447within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6448anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6449
6450@cindex holes
6451Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6452moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6453location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6454and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6455doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6456
6457@smallexample
6458SECTIONS
6459@{
6460 output :
6461 @{
6462 file1(.text)
6463 . = . + 1000;
6464 file2(.text)
6465 . += 1000;
6466 file3(.text)
563e308f 6467 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6468@}
6469@end smallexample
6470@noindent
6471In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6472located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6473followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6474@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6475@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6476specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6477
5c6bbab8
NC
6478@cindex dot inside sections
6479Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6480current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6481statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6482absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6483however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6484not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6485
6486@smallexample
6487SECTIONS
6488@{
6489 . = 0x100
6490 .text: @{
6491 *(.text)
6492 . = 0x200
6493 @}
6494 . = 0x500
6495 .data: @{
6496 *(.data)
6497 . += 0x600
6498 @}
6499@}
6500@end smallexample
6501
6502The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6503and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6504the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6505much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6506move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6507and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6508the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6509the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6510
b5666f2f
AM
6511@cindex dot outside sections
6512Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6513output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6514needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6515
6516@smallexample
6517SECTIONS
6518@{
6519 start_of_text = . ;
6520 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6521 end_of_text = . ;
6522
6523 start_of_data = . ;
6524 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6525 end_of_data = . ;
6526@}
6527@end smallexample
6528
6529If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6530not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6531between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6532should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6533blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6534the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6535sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6536statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6537special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6538place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6539as follows:
6540
6541@smallexample
6542SECTIONS
6543@{
6544 start_of_text = . ;
6545 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6546 end_of_text = . ;
6547
6548 start_of_data = . ;
6549 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6550 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6551 end_of_data = . ;
6552@}
6553@end smallexample
6554
6555This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6556@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6557placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6558assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6559a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6560section. So you could write:
6561
6562@smallexample
6563SECTIONS
6564@{
6565 start_of_text = . ;
6566 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6567 end_of_text = . ;
6568
6569 . = . ;
6570 start_of_data = . ;
6571 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6572 end_of_data = . ;
6573@}
6574@end smallexample
6575
6576Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6577@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6578
252b5132
RH
6579@need 2000
6580@node Operators
6581@subsection Operators
6582@cindex operators for arithmetic
6583@cindex arithmetic operators
6584@cindex precedence in expressions
6585The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6586the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6587@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6588@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6589@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6590@smallexample
6591precedence associativity Operators Notes
6592(highest)
65931 left ! - ~ (1)
65942 left * / %
65953 left + -
65964 left >> <<
65975 left == != > < <= >=
65986 left &
65997 left |
66008 left &&
66019 left ||
660210 right ? :
660311 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6604(lowest)
6605@end smallexample
6606Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6607(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6608(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6609@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6610@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6611@tex
6612\vskip \baselineskip
6613%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6614\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6615\hrule
6616\halign
6617{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6618height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6619&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6620height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6621\noalign{\hrule}
6622height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6623&highest&&&&&\cr
6624% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6625&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6626&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6627&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6628&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6629&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6630&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6631&7&&left&&|&\cr
6632&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6633&9&&left&&||&\cr
6634&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6635&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6636&lowest&&&&&\cr
6637height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6638\hrule}
6639@end tex
6640@iftex
6641{
6642@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6643@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6644@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6645}
6646@end iftex
6647@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6648
6649@node Evaluation
6650@subsection Evaluation
6651@cindex lazy evaluation
6652@cindex expression evaluation order
6653The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6654an expression when absolutely necessary.
6655
6656The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6657address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6658regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6659as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6660
6661However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6662until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6663other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6664for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6665
6666The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6667assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6668allocation.
6669
6670Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6671@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6672
6673If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6674available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6675following
6676@smallexample
6677@group
6678SECTIONS
6679 @{
a1ab1d2a 6680 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6681 @{ *(.text) @}
6682 @}
6683@end group
6684@end smallexample
6685@noindent
6686will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6687address}.
6688
6689@node Expression Section
6690@subsection The Section of an Expression
6691@cindex expression sections
6692@cindex absolute expressions
6693@cindex relative expressions
6694@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6695@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6696@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6697Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6698relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6699using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6700value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6701symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6702operations.
6703
abf4be64
AM
6704Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6705section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6706address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6707@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6708functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6709One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6710(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6711differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6712versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6713section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6714Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6715absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6716given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6717everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6718
6719In the following simple example,
252b5132 6720
7542af2a
AM
6721@smallexample
6722@group
6723SECTIONS
6724 @{
6725 . = 0x100;
6726 __executable_start = 0x100;
6727 .data :
6728 @{
6729 . = 0x10;
6730 __data_start = 0x10;
6731 *(.data)
6732 @}
6733 @dots{}
6734 @}
6735@end group
6736@end smallexample
252b5132 6737
7542af2a
AM
6738both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6739address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6740@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6741section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6742
5c3049d2
AM
6743For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6744addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6745
6746@itemize @bullet
6747@item
c05f749e
AM
6748Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6749operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6750absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6751@item
7542af2a
AM
6752Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6753relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6754and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6755@item
c05f749e
AM
6756Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6757in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6758address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6759before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6760@end itemize
6761
6762The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6763
6764@itemize @bullet
6765@item
6766An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6767@item
6768The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6769@item
9bc8bb33 6770The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6771relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6772(after above conversions) is also a number when
6773@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6774but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6775@item
6776The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6777relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6778section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6779@item
6780The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6781conversions) is an absolute address.
6782@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6783
6784You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6785to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6786create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6787section @samp{.data}:
6788@smallexample
6789SECTIONS
6790 @{
6791 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6792 @}
6793@end smallexample
6794@noindent
6795If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6796@samp{.data} section.
6797
7542af2a
AM
6798Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6799particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6800
252b5132
RH
6801@node Builtin Functions
6802@subsection Builtin Functions
6803@cindex functions in expressions
6804The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6805use in linker script expressions.
6806
6807@table @code
6808@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6809@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6810@cindex expression, absolute
6811Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6812of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6813value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6814normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6815
6816@item ADDR(@var{section})
6817@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6818@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6819Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6820script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6821the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6822@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6823@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6824the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6825@smallexample
6826@group
6827SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6828 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6829 @{
252b5132
RH
6830 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6831 @dots{}
6832 @}
6833 .output :
6834 @{
6835 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6836 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6837 @}
6838@dots{} @}
6839@end group
6840@end smallexample
6841
876f4090
NS
6842@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6843@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6844@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6845@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6846@cindex round up location counter
6847@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6848@cindex round up expression
6849@cindex align expression
6850Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6851to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6852doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6853arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6854expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6855equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6856
6857Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6858next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6859variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6860input sections:
252b5132
RH
6861@smallexample
6862@group
6863SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6864 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6865 *(.data)
6866 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6867 @}
6868@dots{} @}
6869@end group
6870@end smallexample
6871@noindent
6872The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6873a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6874a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6875of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6876
6877The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6878
362c1d1a
NS
6879@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6880@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6881@cindex section alignment
6882Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6883been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6884evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6885the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6886value in that section.
6887@smallexample
6888@group
6889SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6890 .output @{
6891 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6892 @dots{}
6893 @}
6894@dots{} @}
6895@end group
6896@end smallexample
6897
252b5132
RH
6898@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6899@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6900This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6901scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6902section.
6903
2d20f7bf
JJ
6904@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6905@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6906This is equivalent to either
6907@smallexample
6908(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6909@end smallexample
6910or
6911@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6912(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6913 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6914@end smallexample
6915@noindent
6916depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6917for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6918@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6919If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6920memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6921bytes in the on-disk file.
6922
6923This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6924any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6925@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6926be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6927running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6928that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6929page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6930
6931@noindent
6932Example:
6933@smallexample
6934 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6935@end smallexample
6936
6937@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6938@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6939This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6940evaluation purposes.
6941
6942@smallexample
6943 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6944@end smallexample
6945
a4f5ad88
JJ
6946@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6947@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6948This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6949@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6950When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6951does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6952@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6953argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6954script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6955@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6956padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6957section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6958
6959@smallexample
6960 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6961@end smallexample
6962
252b5132
RH
6963@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6964@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6965@cindex symbol defaults
6966Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6967defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6968return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6969default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6970shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6971the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6972existed, its value is preserved:
6973
6974@smallexample
6975@group
6976SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6977 .text : @{
6978 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6979 @dots{}
6980 @}
6981 @dots{}
6982@}
6983@end group
6984@end smallexample
6985
3ec57632
NC
6986@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6987@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6988Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6989
252b5132
RH
6990@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6991@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6992@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6993Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6994Section LMA}).
6995
2e53f7d6
NC
6996@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6997@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6998Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6999@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7000
252b5132
RH
7001@kindex MAX
7002@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7003Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7004
7005@kindex MIN
7006@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7007Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7008
7009@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7010@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7011@cindex unallocated address, next
7012Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7013This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7014use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7015output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7016
3ec57632
NC
7017@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7018@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7019Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7020
ba916c8a
MM
7021@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7022@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7023Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7024value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7025@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7026will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7027can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7028``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7029name.
7030
252b5132
RH
7031@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7032@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7033@cindex section size
7034Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7035been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7036evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7037@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7038@smallexample
7039@group
7040SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7041 .output @{
7042 .start = . ;
7043 @dots{}
7044 .end = . ;
7045 @}
7046 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7047 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7048@dots{} @}
7049@end group
7050@end smallexample
7051
7052@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7053@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7054@cindex header size
7055Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7056information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7057this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7058choose, to facilitate paging.
7059
7060@cindex not enough room for program headers
7061@cindex program headers, not enough room
7062When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7063@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7064number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7065addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7066additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7067room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7068the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7069script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7070you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7071command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7072@end table
7073
7074@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7075@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7076@cindex implicit linker scripts
7077If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7078an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7079linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7080linker will report an error.
7081
7082An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7083
7084Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7085assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7086commands.
7087
7088Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7089at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7090read. This can affect archive searching.
7091
bf6d8037
HC
7092@node Plugins
7093@chapter Linker Plugins
7094
7095@cindex plugins
7096@cindex linker plugins
7097The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7098For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7099support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7100
7101Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7102be added here later.
7103
7104@menu
7105* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7106@end menu
7107
7108@node libdep Plugin
7109@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7110@cindex static library dependencies
7111Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7112just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7113optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7114within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7115rose to ascendance.
7116
7117One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7118multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7119dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7120library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7121referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7122link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7123libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7124explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7125
7126The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7127to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7128plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7129dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7130and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7131command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7132utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7133being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7134archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7135
7136For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7137library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7138the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7139
7140@smallexample
7141-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7142@end smallexample
7143
252b5132
RH
7144@ifset GENERIC
7145@node Machine Dependent
7146@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7147
7148@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7149@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7150sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7151functionality are not listed.
7152
7153@menu
36f63dca
NC
7154@ifset H8300
7155* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7156@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7157@ifset M68HC11
7158* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7159@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7160@ifset ARM
7161* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7162@end ifset
7163@ifset HPPA
7164* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7165@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7166@ifset M68K
7167* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7168@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7169@ifset MIPS
7170* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7171@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7172@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7173* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7174@end ifset
2469cfa2 7175@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7176* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7177@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7178@ifset NDS32
7179* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7180@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7181@ifset NIOSII
7182* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7183@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7184@ifset POWERPC
7185* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7186@end ifset
7187@ifset POWERPC64
7188* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7189@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7190@ifset S/390
7191* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7192@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7193@ifset SPU
7194* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7195@end ifset
74459f0e 7196@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7197* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7198@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7199@ifset WIN32
7200* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7201@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7202@ifset XTENSA
7203* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7204@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7205@end menu
7206@end ifset
7207
252b5132
RH
7208@ifset H8300
7209@ifclear GENERIC
7210@raisesections
7211@end ifclear
7212
7213@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7214@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7215
7216@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7217For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7218you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7219
7220@table @emph
7221@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7222@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7223@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7224targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7225program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7226respectively.
7227
7228@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7229@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7230@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7231@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7232sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7233page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7234(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7235@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7236top page of memory).
1502569c 7237
81f5558e
NC
7238@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7239indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7240displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7241the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7242@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7243whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7244range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7245
1502569c 7246@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7247@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7248biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7249which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7250page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7251(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7252@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7253the top page of memory).
7254
7255@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7256@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
725732 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7258changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7259(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7260@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7261the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7262@end table
7263
7264@ifclear GENERIC
7265@lowersections
7266@end ifclear
7267@end ifset
7268
36f63dca 7269@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7270@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7271@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7272@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7273@node Renesas
7274@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7275
c2dcd04e
NC
7276@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7277H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7278options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7279@end ifset
7280@end ifclear
7281
36f63dca
NC
7282@ifset ARM
7283@ifclear GENERIC
7284@raisesections
7285@end ifclear
7286
93fd0973
SC
7287@ifset M68HC11
7288@ifclear GENERIC
7289@raisesections
7290@end ifclear
7291
7292@node M68HC11/68HC12
7293@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7294
7295@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7296
7297@subsection Linker Relaxation
7298
7299For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7300optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7301
7302@table @emph
7303@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7304@item relaxing address modes
7305@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7306targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7307program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7308respectively.
7309
7310@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7311transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7312page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7313
7314@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7315When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7316of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7317addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7318@code{bset} instructions.
7319
7320@end table
7321
7322@subsection Trampoline Generation
7323
7324@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7325@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7326For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7327call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7328will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7329trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7330case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7331point to the function trampoline.
7332
7333@ifclear GENERIC
7334@lowersections
7335@end ifclear
7336@end ifset
7337
36f63dca 7338@node ARM
3674e28a 7339@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7340
7341@cindex ARM interworking support
7342@kindex --support-old-code
7343For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7344between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7345been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7346line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7347libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7348option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7349given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7350which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7351the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7352non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7353
7354@cindex thumb entry point
7355@cindex entry point, thumb
7356@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7357The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7358@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7359But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7360branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7361executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7362
ce11ba6c
KT
7363@cindex PE import table prefixing
7364@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7365The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7366the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7367element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7368import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7369
e489d0ae
PB
7370@cindex BE8
7371@kindex --be8
7372The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7373executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7374objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7375option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7376little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7377
3674e28a
PB
7378@cindex TARGET1
7379@kindex --target1-rel
7380@kindex --target1-abs
7381The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7382@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7383or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7384and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7385
7386@cindex TARGET2
7387@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7388The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7389@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7390meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7391@table @samp
7392@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7393@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7394@item abs
a57d1773 7395@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7396@item got-rel
7397@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7398@end table
7399
319850b4
JB
7400@cindex FIX_V4BX
7401@kindex --fix-v4bx
7402The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7403specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7404interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7405also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7406
7407In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7408linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7409@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7410
7411In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7412relocations are ignored.
7413
845b51d6
PB
7414@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7415@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7416Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7417relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7418
7419@smallexample
7420TST rM, #1
7421MOVEQ PC, rM
7422BX Rn
7423@end smallexample
7424
7425This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7426and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7427condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7428
33bfe774
JB
7429@cindex USE_BLX
7430@kindex --use-blx
7431The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7432BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7433situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7434code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7435each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7436
c6dd86c6
JB
7437@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7438@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7439The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7440bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7441instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7442to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7443the support code can read the intended values.
7444
7445The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7446intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7447and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7448intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7449full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7450you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7451
7452If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7453enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7454@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7455mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7456vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7457@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7458
7459If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7460potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7461such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7462first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7463instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7464the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7465are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7466
2de70689
MGD
7467@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7468@kindex --fix-arm1176
7469@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7470The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7471in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7472are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7473unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7474
9d5777a3 7475Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7476Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7477http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7478
a504d23a
LA
7479@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7480@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7481
7482The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7483workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7484the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7485off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7486the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7487core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7488integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7489VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7490
7491The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7492necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7493
7494The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7495@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7496STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7497linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7498@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7499
7500If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7501potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7502such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7503replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7504branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7505then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7506
7507The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7508the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7509
7510The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7511they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7512there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7513occurs.
7514
7515The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7516PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7517large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7518cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7519occurs.
7520
bf21ed78
MS
7521@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7522@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7523The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7524warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7525enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7526linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7527using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7528not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7529
7530@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7531@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7532The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7533warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7534@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7535linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7536using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7537
726150b7
NC
7538@cindex PIC_VENEER
7539@kindex --pic-veneer
7540The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7541ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7542is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7543@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7544
7545@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7546@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7547The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7548code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7549perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7550placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7551controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7552The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7553duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7554group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7555code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7556where they should be placed.
7557
7558The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7559@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7560placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7561branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7562placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7563value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7564exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7565A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7566linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7567from the input sections.
7568
7569The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7570@samp{N = +1}.
7571
1a51c1a4
NC
7572Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7573only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7574otherwise.
7575
1db37fe6
YG
7576@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7577@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7578@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7579The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7580
7581The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7582
68fcca92
JW
7583@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7584@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7585@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7586The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7587
7588Please contact ARM for further details.
7589
1db37fe6
YG
7590@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7591@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7592@cindex Merging exidx entries
7593The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7594
7595@kindex --long-plt
7596@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7597The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7598which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7599entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7600
1f56df9d
JW
7601@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7602@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7603The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7604link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7605
4ba2ef8f
TP
7606@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7607All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7608Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7609@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7610veneers in memory.
7611
54ddd295
TP
7612@kindex --cmse-implib
7613@cindex Secure gateway import library
7614The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7615specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7616secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7617executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7618
0955507f
TP
7619@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7620@cindex Input import library
7621The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7622must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7623given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7624in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7625@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7626library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7627library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7628for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7629specified.
7630
36f63dca
NC
7631@ifclear GENERIC
7632@lowersections
7633@end ifclear
7634@end ifset
7635
7636@ifset HPPA
7637@ifclear GENERIC
7638@raisesections
7639@end ifclear
7640
7641@node HPPA ELF32
7642@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7643@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7644@kindex --multi-subspace
7645When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7646import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7647The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7648stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7649multiple sub-spaces.
7650
7651@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7652@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7653Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7654stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7655@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7656sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7657a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7658the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7659conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7660prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7661A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7662branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7663@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7664@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7665detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7666positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7667
7668Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7669single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7670create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7671large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7672
7673@ifclear GENERIC
7674@lowersections
7675@end ifclear
7676@end ifset
7677
7fb9f789
NC
7678@ifset M68K
7679@ifclear GENERIC
7680@raisesections
7681@end ifclear
7682
7683@node M68K
7684@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7685
7686@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7687@kindex --got=@var{type}
7688The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7689The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7690@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7691the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7692@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7693entries only at non-negative offsets.
7694@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7695entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7696support such GOTs.
7697@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7698output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7699file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7700files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7701
7702@ifclear GENERIC
7703@lowersections
7704@end ifclear
7705@end ifset
7706
833794fc
MR
7707@ifset MIPS
7708@ifclear GENERIC
7709@raisesections
7710@end ifclear
7711
7712@node MIPS
7713@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7714
7715@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7716@kindex --insn32
7717@kindex --no-insn32
7718The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7719microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7720in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7721used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7722or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7723including 16-bit ones where possible.
7724
8b10b0b3
MR
7725@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7726@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7727@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7728The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7729control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7730@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7731relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7732calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7733relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7734instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7735or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7736the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7737
833794fc
MR
7738@ifclear GENERIC
7739@lowersections
7740@end ifclear
7741@end ifset
7742
36f63dca
NC
7743@ifset MMIX
7744@ifclear GENERIC
7745@raisesections
7746@end ifclear
7747
7748@node MMIX
7749@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7750For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7751@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7752understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7753can translate between the two formats.
7754
7755There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7756Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7757registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7758equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7759@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7760global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7761this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7762symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7763
7a2de473
HPN
7764Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7765@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7766The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7767of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7768
7769Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7770are left out from an mmo file.
7771
7772@ifclear GENERIC
7773@lowersections
7774@end ifclear
7775@end ifset
7776
7777@ifset MSP430
7778@ifclear GENERIC
7779@raisesections
7780@end ifclear
7781
7782@node MSP430
7783@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7784For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7785will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7786just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7787
7788@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7789The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7790
7791@table @code
7792@item @samp{.vectors}
7793Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7794
7795@item @samp{.bootloader}
7796Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7797in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7798
7799@item @samp{.infomem}
7800Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7801this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7802
c0065db7 7803@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7804This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7805in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7806
7807@item @samp{.noinit}
7808Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7809
c0065db7 7810The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7811@end table
7812
7ef3addb
JL
7813@table @option
7814@cindex MSP430 Options
7815@kindex --code-region
7816@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7817This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7818argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7819using this option.
7820
7821@kindex --data-region
7822@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7823This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7824[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7825for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7826
7827@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7828@item --disable-sec-transformation
7829Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7830and @code{--data-region} options.
7831This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7832wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7833not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7834@end table
7835
36f63dca
NC
7836@ifclear GENERIC
7837@lowersections
7838@end ifclear
7839@end ifset
7840
35c08157
KLC
7841@ifset NDS32
7842@ifclear GENERIC
7843@raisesections
7844@end ifclear
7845
7846@node NDS32
7847@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7848@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7849For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7850relaxes objects according to these options.
7851
7852@table @code
7853@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7854Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7855
7856@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7857Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7858
7859@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7860Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7861
7862@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7863Export the EX9 table after linking.
7864
7865@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7866Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7867
7868@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7869Update the existing EX9 table.
7870
7871@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7872Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7873
7874@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7875Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7876
7877@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7878Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7879
7880@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7881Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7882@end table
7883
7884@ifclear GENERIC
7885@lowersections
7886@end ifclear
7887@end ifset
7888
78058a5e
SL
7889@ifset NIOSII
7890@ifclear GENERIC
7891@raisesections
7892@end ifclear
7893
7894@node Nios II
7895@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7896@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7897@kindex --relax on Nios II
7898
7899Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7900transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7901which may result in @command{ld} giving
7902@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7903The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7904trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7905outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7906trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7907be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7908larger than 256MB.
7909
7910The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7911is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7912@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7913locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7914source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7915register as a temporary.
7916
7917Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7918relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7919option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7920
7921@ifclear GENERIC
7922@lowersections
7923@end ifclear
7924@end ifset
7925
2a60a7a8
AM
7926@ifset POWERPC
7927@ifclear GENERIC
7928@raisesections
7929@end ifclear
7930
7931@node PowerPC ELF32
7932@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7933@cindex PowerPC long branches
7934@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7935Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7936displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7937@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7938@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7939the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7940section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7941section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7942@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7943both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7944considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7945
7946@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7947@table @option
7948@cindex PowerPC PLT
7949@kindex --bss-plt
7950@item --bss-plt
7951Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7952generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7953the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7954writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7955@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7956PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7957compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7958BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7959
016687f8
AM
7960@kindex --secure-plt
7961@item --secure-plt
7962@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7963@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7964when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7965layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7966style BSS PLT.
7967
2a60a7a8
AM
7968@cindex PowerPC GOT
7969@kindex --sdata-got
7970@item --sdata-got
7971The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7972sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7973@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7974section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7975@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7976@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7977@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7978@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7979PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7980pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7981GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7982really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7983
7984@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7985@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7986@item --emit-stub-syms
7987This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7988symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7989
7990@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7991@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7992@item --no-tls-optimize
7993PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7994sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7995disable the optimization.
7996@end table
7997
7998@ifclear GENERIC
7999@lowersections
8000@end ifclear
8001@end ifset
8002
8003@ifset POWERPC64
8004@ifclear GENERIC
8005@raisesections
8006@end ifclear
8007
8008@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8009@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8010
8011@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8012@table @option
8013@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8014@kindex --stub-group-size
8015@item --stub-group-size
8016Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8017by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8018@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8019sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8020a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8021the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8022conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8023prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8024A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8025branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8026@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8027@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8028detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8029positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8030
8031Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8032single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8033create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8034large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8035
8036@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8037@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8038@item --emit-stub-syms
8039This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8040symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8041
8042@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8043@kindex --dotsyms
8044@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8045@item --dotsyms
8046@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8047These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8048in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8049function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8050code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8051properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8052to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8053@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8054dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8055feature.
8056
7ae4ea7d
AM
8057@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8058@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8059@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8060@item --save-restore-funcs
8061@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8062These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8063provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8064@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8065function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8066link.
8067
2a60a7a8
AM
8068@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8069@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8070@item --no-tls-optimize
8071PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8072sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8073disable the optimization.
8074
7c9cf415
AM
8075@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8076@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8077@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8078@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8079@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8080@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8081@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8082These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8083stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8084an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8085@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8086stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8087generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8088__tls_get_addr_opt.
8089Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8090much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8091an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8092will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8093@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8094and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8095this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8096Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8097@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8098register saves.
7c9cf415 8099
2a60a7a8
AM
8100@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8101@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8102@item --no-opd-optimize
8103PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8104corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8105the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8106Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8107
8108@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8109@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8110@item --non-overlapping-opd
8111Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8112@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8113the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8114entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8115
8116@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8117@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8118@item --no-toc-optimize
8119PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8120entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8121reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8122marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8123marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8124relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8125unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8126reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8127discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8128reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8129code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8130optimization.
8131
d882c988
AM
8132@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8133@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8134@item --no-inline-optimize
8135PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8136marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8137@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8138a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8139locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8140disables that optimization.
8141
2a60a7a8
AM
8142@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8143@kindex --no-multi-toc
8144@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8145If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8146@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8147where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8148entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8149total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8150grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8151TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8152calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8153help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
815464K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8155Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8156
8157@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8158@kindex --no-toc-sort
8159@item --no-toc-sort
8160By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8161happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8162placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8163with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8164referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8165@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8166results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8167off this feature.
8168
8169@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8170@kindex --plt-align
8171@kindex --no-plt-align
8172@item --plt-align
8173@itemx --no-plt-align
8174Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8175aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8176boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8177specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8178specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8179if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8180PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8181
8182@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8183@kindex --plt-static-chain
8184@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8185@item --plt-static-chain
8186@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8187Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8188chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8189chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8190
8191@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8192@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8193@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8194@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8195@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8196With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8197lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8198another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8199order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8200memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8201barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8202looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8203seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8204default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8205
8206@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8207@kindex --plt-localentry
8208@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8209@item --plt-localentry
8210@itemx --no-localentry
8211ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8212ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8213(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8214Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8215or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8216functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8217in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8218interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8219including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8220to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8221complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8222care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8223
8224@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8225@kindex --power10-stubs
8226@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8227@item --power10-stubs
8228@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8229When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8230relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8231linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8232for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8233power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8234power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8235allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8236@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8237auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8238@end table
8239
8240@ifclear GENERIC
8241@lowersections
8242@end ifclear
8243@end ifset
8244
b4cbbe8f
AK
8245@ifset S/390
8246@ifclear GENERIC
8247@raisesections
8248@end ifclear
8249
8250@node S/390 ELF
8251@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8252
8253@cindex S/390 ELF options
8254@table @option
8255
8256@cindex S/390
8257@kindex --s390-pgste
8258@item --s390-pgste
8259This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8260segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8261binaries marked that way.
8262@end table
8263
8264@ifclear GENERIC
8265@lowersections
8266@end ifclear
8267@end ifset
8268
49fa1e15
AM
8269@ifset SPU
8270@ifclear GENERIC
8271@raisesections
8272@end ifclear
8273
8274@node SPU ELF
8275@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8276
8277@cindex SPU ELF options
8278@table @option
8279
8280@cindex SPU plugins
8281@kindex --plugin
8282@item --plugin
8283This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8284
8285@cindex SPU overlays
8286@kindex --no-overlays
8287@item --no-overlays
8288Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8289regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8290@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8291turns off all this special overlay handling.
8292
8293@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8294@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8295@item --emit-stub-syms
8296This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8297symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8298
8299@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8300@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8301@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8302This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8303function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8304on calls to non-overlay regions.
8305
8306@cindex SPU local store size
8307@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8308@item --local-store=lo:hi
8309@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8310the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8311range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8312
c0065db7 8313@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8314@kindex --stack-analysis
8315@item --stack-analysis
8316SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8317unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8318under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8319@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8320@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8321determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8322for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8323for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8324for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8325find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8326and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8327under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8328dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8329is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8330and calls will be given.
8331
c0065db7 8332@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8333@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8334@item --emit-stack-syms
8335This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8336in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8337These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8338functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8339functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8340such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8341The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8342@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8343@end table
8344
8345@ifclear GENERIC
8346@lowersections
8347@end ifclear
8348@end ifset
8349
36f63dca
NC
8350@ifset TICOFF
8351@ifclear GENERIC
8352@raisesections
8353@end ifclear
8354
8355@node TI COFF
8356@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8357@cindex TI COFF versions
8358@kindex --format=@var{version}
8359The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8360TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8361also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8362format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8363header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8364
8365@ifclear GENERIC
8366@lowersections
8367@end ifclear
8368@end ifset
8369
2ca22b03
NC
8370@ifset WIN32
8371@ifclear GENERIC
8372@raisesections
8373@end ifclear
8374
8375@node WIN32
8376@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8377
c0065db7 8378This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8379See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8380command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8381
8382@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8383@cindex import libraries
8384@item import libraries
69da35b5 8385The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8386libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8387regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8388archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8389support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8390@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8391
c0065db7
RM
8392@item exporting DLL symbols
8393@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8394The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8395
8396@table @emph
8397@item using auto-export functionality
8398@cindex using auto-export functionality
8399By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8400which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8401
0a5d968e
NC
8402@itemize
8403@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8404@item --exclude-symbols
8405@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8406@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8407@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8408@end itemize
8409
09e2aba4
DK
8410When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8411(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8412symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8413often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8414private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8415options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8416exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8417final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8418
8419If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8420command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8421if either of the following are true:
8422
8423@itemize
8424@item A DEF file is used.
8425@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8426@end itemize
dc8465bf 8427
c0065db7
RM
8428@item using a DEF file
8429@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8430Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8431an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8432exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8433name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8434command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8435
8436@example
8437gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8438@end example
8439
0a5d968e
NC
8440Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8441@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8442
dc8465bf
NC
8443Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8444
8445@example
4b5bd4e7 8446LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8447
8448EXPORTS
8449foo
8450bar
8451_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8452another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8453var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8454doo = foo == foo2
8455eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8456@end example
dc8465bf 8457
7fcab871 8458This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8459symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8460alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8461by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8462@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8463@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8464export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8465in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8466symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8467
6b31ad16
DS
8468The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8469name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8470the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8471
b45619c0
NC
8472When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8473library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8474@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8475executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8476
8477With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8478specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8479non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8480
8481If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8482or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8483filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8484
4b5bd4e7
DS
8485The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8486
8487@example
8488EXPORTS
8489 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8490 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8491 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8492@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8493
8494Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8495@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8496@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8497@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8498Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8499@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8500string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8501
8502The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8503
8504@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8505will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8506by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8507linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8508library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8509
8510@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8511The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8512the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8513@code{*_imp__foo}).
8514
8515@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8516well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8517read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8518variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8519the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8520extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8521application will behave unexpectedly.
8522
8523@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8524it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8525symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8526API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8527the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8528
4b5bd4e7
DS
8529See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8530other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8531
8532@cindex creating a DEF file
8533While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8534with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8535
8536@item Using decorations
8537@cindex Using decorations
8538Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8539itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8540declared as:
8541
8542@example
8543__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8544__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8545@end example
8546
8547All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8548any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8549this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8550the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8551
8552Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8553decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8554instead:
8555
8556@example
8557__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8558__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8559@end example
8560
c0065db7
RM
8561This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8562when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8563variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8564code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8565of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8566omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8567@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8568information.
c0065db7 8569@end table
dc8465bf 8570
2ca22b03
NC
8571@cindex automatic data imports
8572@item automatic data imports
8573The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8574by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8575compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8576issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8577code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8578c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8579initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8580decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8581platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8582command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8583The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8584suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8585trigger the feature's use.
8586
c0065db7 8587auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8588additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8589
c0065db7 8590"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8591documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8592
c0065db7
RM
8593The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8594occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8595One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8596below.
8597
8598@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8599For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8600object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8601offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8602field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8603in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8604without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8605The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8606references.
8607
c0065db7
RM
8608The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8609be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8610themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8611runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8612compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8613support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8614run without error on an older system.
8615
c0065db7
RM
8616@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8617enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8618
8619@cindex direct linking to a dll
8620@item direct linking to a dll
8621The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8622including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8623libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8624traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8625libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8626function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8627though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8628storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8629tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8630large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8631
c0065db7 8632Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8633@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8634of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8635perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8636select the dll instead of an import library.
8637
2ca22b03 8638
69da35b5
NC
8639For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8640to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8641
8642@example
45e948fe
NC
8643libxxx.dll.a
8644xxx.dll.a
8645libxxx.a
8646xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8647libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8648cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8649libxxx.dll
8650xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8651@end example
8652
69da35b5
NC
8653before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8654
c0065db7
RM
8655(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8656where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8657@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8658file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8659@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8660
c0065db7
RM
8661Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8662@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8663was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8664various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8665could coexist on the same machine.
8666
2ca22b03
NC
8667The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8668applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8669libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8670
8671@example
8672bin/
8673 cygxxx.dll
8674lib/
8675 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8676 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8677@end example
8678
c0065db7
RM
8679Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8680done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8681
86821. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8683@example
8684gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8685@end example
2ca22b03 8686
69da35b5
NC
8687However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8688(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8689@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8690not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8691
2ca22b03
NC
86922. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8693directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8694should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8695making the app/dll.
8696
8697@example
8698ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8699@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8700
8701Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8702
8703@example
8704gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8705@end example
69da35b5
NC
8706
8707This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8708perfectly legal
8709
8710@example
8711bin/
8712 cygxxx-5.dll
8713lib/
c0065db7 8714 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8715@end example
8716
dc8465bf 8717Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8718even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8719@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8720
8721Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8722wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8723
87241. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8725work with auto-imported data.
8726
dc8465bf
NC
87272. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8728import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8729symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8730for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8731possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8732
45e948fe
NC
87333. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8734critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8735in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8736stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8737
69da35b5 8738So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8739true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8740a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8741binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8742massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8743requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8744will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8745
c0065db7 8746@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8747@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8748@item adding additional names
8749Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8750A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8751exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8752when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8753import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8754
c0065db7 8755@example
dc8465bf
NC
8756LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8757
8758EXPORTS
c0065db7 8759foo
dc8465bf 8760_foo = foo
c0065db7 8761@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8762
8763The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8764
8765Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8766source code using the "weak" attribute:
8767
c0065db7
RM
8768@example
8769void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8770void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8771@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8772
8773See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8774symbols.
8775
8776@item renaming symbols
8777Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8778kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8779@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8780DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8781created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8782
c0065db7 8783@example
dc8465bf
NC
8784LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8785
8786EXPORTS
8787_foo = foo
c0065db7 8788@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8789
8790The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8791@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8792@end table
dc8465bf 8793
0a5d968e 8794Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8795unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8796If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8797@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8798that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8799@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8800renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8801to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8802the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8803In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8804which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8805
8806@cindex weak externals
8807@item weak externals
8808The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8809weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8810defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8811are three variants of weak externals:
8812@itemize
8813@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8814called lazy externals.
8815@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8816This form is not presently implemented.
8817@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8818implemented.
8819@end itemize
8820As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8821are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8822uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8823
8824@cindex aligned common symbols
8825@item aligned common symbols
8826As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8827desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8828the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8829carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8830by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8831tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8832but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8833warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8834
2ca22b03
NC
8835@end table
8836
8837@ifclear GENERIC
8838@lowersections
8839@end ifclear
8840@end ifset
8841
e0001a05
NC
8842@ifset XTENSA
8843@ifclear GENERIC
8844@raisesections
8845@end ifclear
8846
8847@node Xtensa
8848@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8849
8850@cindex Xtensa processors
8851The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8852@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8853specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8854keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8855example, with the command:
8856
8857@smallexample
8858SECTIONS
8859@{
8860 .text : @{
8861 *(.literal .text)
8862 @}
8863@}
8864@end smallexample
8865
8866@noindent
8867@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8868and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8869literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8870interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8871group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8872files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8873and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8874
43cd72b9 8875@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8876@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8877Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8878provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8879is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8880literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8881will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8882location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8883the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8884unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8885@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8886range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8887
8888For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8889to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8890instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8891instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8892instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8893@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8894hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8895By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8896switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8897density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8898instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8899performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8900linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8901a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8902
8903The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8904control the linker:
8905
8906@cindex Xtensa options
8907@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8908@item --size-opt
8909When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8910more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8911no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8912alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8913preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8914
8915@item --abi-windowed
8916@itemx --abi-call0
8917Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8918PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8919because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8920conventions.
8921Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8922of the first input object.
8923A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8924or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8925@end table
e0001a05
NC
8926
8927@ifclear GENERIC
8928@lowersections
8929@end ifclear
8930@end ifset
8931
252b5132
RH
8932@ifclear SingleFormat
8933@node BFD
8934@chapter BFD
8935
8936@cindex back end
8937@cindex object file management
8938@cindex object formats available
8939@kindex objdump -i
8940The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8941These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8942object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8943format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8944it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8945associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8946object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8947(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8948list all the formats available for your configuration.
8949
8950@cindex BFD requirements
8951@cindex requirements for BFD
8952As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8953several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8954BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8955formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8956been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8957BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8958may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8959
8960One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8961mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8962useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8963conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8964
8965@menu
8966* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8967@end menu
8968
8969@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8970@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8971@cindex opening object files
8972@include bfdsumm.texi
8973@end ifclear
8974
8975@node Reporting Bugs
8976@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8977@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8978@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8979
ff5dcc92 8980Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8981
8982Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8983it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8984to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8985work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8986@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8987
8988In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8989information that enables us to fix the bug.
8990
8991@menu
8992* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8993* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8994@end menu
8995
8996@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8997@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8998@cindex bug criteria
8999
9000If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9001
9002@itemize @bullet
9003@cindex fatal signal
9004@cindex linker crash
9005@cindex crash of linker
9006@item
9007If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9008@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9009
9010@cindex error on valid input
9011@item
ff5dcc92 9012If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9013
9014@cindex invalid input
9015@item
ff5dcc92 9016If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9017may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9018object files are correct.
9019
9020@item
9021If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9022improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9023@end itemize
9024
9025@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9026@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9027@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9028@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9029
9030A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9031products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9032recommend you contact that organization first.
9033
9034You can find contact information for many support companies and
9035individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9036distribution.
9037
ad22bfe8 9038@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9039Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9040@value{BUGURL}.
9041@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9042
9043The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9044@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9045fact or leave it out, state it!
9046
9047Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9048problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9049assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9050matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9051the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9052location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9053were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9054into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9055specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9056and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9057
9058Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9059the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9060on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9061
9062Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9063bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9064respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9065You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9066
9067To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9068
9069@itemize @bullet
9070@item
ff5dcc92 9071The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9072the @samp{--version} argument.
9073
9074Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9075the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9076
9077@item
ff5dcc92 9078Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9079patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9080
9081@item
9082The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9083version number.
9084
9085@item
ff5dcc92 9086What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9087``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9088
9089@item
9090The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9091observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9092list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9093sufficient.
9094
9095If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9096and then we might not encounter the bug.
9097
9098@item
9099A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9100bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9101provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9102bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9103state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9104requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9105we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9106attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9107
9108If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9109@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9110object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9111@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9112how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9113
9114@item
9115A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9116incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9117
ff5dcc92 9118Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9119will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9120not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9121a chance to make a mistake.
9122
9123Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9124say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9125copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9126C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9127and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9128fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9129you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9130any conclusion from our observations.
9131
9132@item
ff5dcc92 9133If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9134diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9135@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9136If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9137context, not by line number.
9138
9139The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9140sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9141@end itemize
9142
9143Here are some things that are not necessary:
9144
9145@itemize @bullet
9146@item
9147A description of the envelope of the bug.
9148
9149Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9150which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9151changes will not affect it.
9152
9153This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9154will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9155with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9156We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9157
9158Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9159of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9160output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9161less time, and so on.
9162
9163However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9164report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9165
9166@item
9167A patch for the bug.
9168
9169A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9170the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9171a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9172to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9173
ff5dcc92 9174Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9175construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9176through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9177able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9178fixed.
9179
9180And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9181patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9182help us to understand.
9183
9184@item
9185A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9186
9187Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9188things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9189@end itemize
9190
9191@node MRI
9192@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9193@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9194To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9195linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9196alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9197described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9198simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9199@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9200linker commands; these commands are described here.
9201
9202In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9203file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9204features to make use of them.
9205
9206You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9207@samp{-c} command-line option.
9208
9209Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9210command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9211blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9212MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9213issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9214
9215Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9216
9217You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9218lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9219The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9220
9221@table @code
9222@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9223@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9224@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9225Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9226the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9227@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9228your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9229script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9230commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9231input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9232@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9233
9234@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9235@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9236Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9237in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9238
9239@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9240
9241@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9242@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9243Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9244@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9245
9246@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9247@item BASE @var{expression}
9248Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9249absolute addresses) in the output file.
9250
9251@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9252@item CHIP @var{expression}
9253@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9254This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9255
9256@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9257@item END
9258This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9259
9260@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9261@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9262Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9263language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9264
9265@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9266@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9267Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9268@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9269
9270The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9271same line, with no change in its effect.
9272
9273@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9274@item LOAD @var{filename}
9275@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9276Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9277same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9278command line.
9279
9280@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9281@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9282@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9283MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9284option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9285
9286@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9287@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9288@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9289Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9290order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9291script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9292sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9293file, in the order specified.
9294
9295@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9296@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9297@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9298@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9299Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9300@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9301
9302@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9303@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9304@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9305@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9306You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9307specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9308If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9309@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9310@end table
9311
793c5807
NC
9312@node GNU Free Documentation License
9313@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9314@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9315
370b66a1
CD
9316@node LD Index
9317@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9318
9319@printindex cp
9320
9321@tex
7ca01ed9 9322% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9323% meantime:
9324\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9325\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9326\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9327\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9328\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9329\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9330\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9331\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9332\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9333% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9334@end tex
9335
252b5132 9336@bye